blob: 57e2c4e43dc2940d051f3b1c9e41fd28e6092ba7 [file] [log] [blame]
Bram Moolenaaraebaf892008-05-28 14:49:58 +00001*eval.txt* For Vim version 7.1. Last change: 2008 May 28
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002
3
4 VIM REFERENCE MANUAL by Bram Moolenaar
5
6
7Expression evaluation *expression* *expr* *E15* *eval*
8
9Using expressions is introduced in chapter 41 of the user manual |usr_41.txt|.
10
11Note: Expression evaluation can be disabled at compile time. If this has been
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +000012done, the features in this document are not available. See |+eval| and
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +000013|no-eval-feature|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000014
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000151. Variables |variables|
16 1.1 Variable types
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +000017 1.2 Function references |Funcref|
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +000018 1.3 Lists |Lists|
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +000019 1.4 Dictionaries |Dictionaries|
20 1.5 More about variables |more-variables|
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000212. Expression syntax |expression-syntax|
223. Internal variable |internal-variables|
234. Builtin Functions |functions|
245. Defining functions |user-functions|
256. Curly braces names |curly-braces-names|
267. Commands |expression-commands|
278. Exception handling |exception-handling|
289. Examples |eval-examples|
2910. No +eval feature |no-eval-feature|
3011. The sandbox |eval-sandbox|
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00003112. Textlock |textlock|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000032
33{Vi does not have any of these commands}
34
35==============================================================================
361. Variables *variables*
37
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000381.1 Variable types ~
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +000039 *E712*
Bram Moolenaar39a58ca2005-06-27 22:42:44 +000040There are five types of variables:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000041
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +000042Number A 32 bit signed number.
43 Examples: -123 0x10 0177
44
45String A NUL terminated string of 8-bit unsigned characters (bytes).
46 Examples: "ab\txx\"--" 'x-z''a,c'
47
48Funcref A reference to a function |Funcref|.
49 Example: function("strlen")
50
51List An ordered sequence of items |List|.
52 Example: [1, 2, ['a', 'b']]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000053
Bram Moolenaar39a58ca2005-06-27 22:42:44 +000054Dictionary An associative, unordered array: Each entry has a key and a
55 value. |Dictionary|
56 Example: {'blue': "#0000ff", 'red': "#ff0000"}
57
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +000058The Number and String types are converted automatically, depending on how they
59are used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000060
61Conversion from a Number to a String is by making the ASCII representation of
62the Number. Examples: >
63 Number 123 --> String "123"
64 Number 0 --> String "0"
65 Number -1 --> String "-1"
66
67Conversion from a String to a Number is done by converting the first digits
68to a number. Hexadecimal "0xf9" and Octal "017" numbers are recognized. If
69the String doesn't start with digits, the result is zero. Examples: >
70 String "456" --> Number 456
71 String "6bar" --> Number 6
72 String "foo" --> Number 0
73 String "0xf1" --> Number 241
74 String "0100" --> Number 64
75 String "-8" --> Number -8
76 String "+8" --> Number 0
77
78To force conversion from String to Number, add zero to it: >
79 :echo "0100" + 0
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +000080< 64 ~
81
82To avoid a leading zero to cause octal conversion, or for using a different
83base, use |str2nr()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +000084
85For boolean operators Numbers are used. Zero is FALSE, non-zero is TRUE.
86
87Note that in the command >
88 :if "foo"
89"foo" is converted to 0, which means FALSE. To test for a non-empty string,
90use strlen(): >
91 :if strlen("foo")
Bram Moolenaar748bf032005-02-02 23:04:36 +000092< *E745* *E728* *E703* *E729* *E730* *E731*
93List, Dictionary and Funcref types are not automatically converted.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +000094
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +000095 *E706*
96You will get an error if you try to change the type of a variable. You need
97to |:unlet| it first to avoid this error. String and Number are considered
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +000098equivalent though. Consider this sequence of commands: >
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +000099 :let l = "string"
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000100 :let l = 44 " changes type from String to Number
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000101 :let l = [1, 2, 3] " error!
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000102
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000103
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00001041.2 Function references ~
Bram Moolenaar748bf032005-02-02 23:04:36 +0000105 *Funcref* *E695* *E718*
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000106A Funcref variable is obtained with the |function()| function. It can be used
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000107in an expression in the place of a function name, before the parenthesis
108around the arguments, to invoke the function it refers to. Example: >
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000109
110 :let Fn = function("MyFunc")
111 :echo Fn()
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000112< *E704* *E705* *E707*
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +0000113A Funcref variable must start with a capital, "s:", "w:", "t:" or "b:". You
114cannot have both a Funcref variable and a function with the same name.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000115
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000116A special case is defining a function and directly assigning its Funcref to a
117Dictionary entry. Example: >
118 :function dict.init() dict
119 : let self.val = 0
120 :endfunction
121
122The key of the Dictionary can start with a lower case letter. The actual
123function name is not used here. Also see |numbered-function|.
124
125A Funcref can also be used with the |:call| command: >
126 :call Fn()
127 :call dict.init()
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000128
129The name of the referenced function can be obtained with |string()|. >
Bram Moolenaar383f9bc2005-01-19 22:18:32 +0000130 :let func = string(Fn)
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000131
132You can use |call()| to invoke a Funcref and use a list variable for the
133arguments: >
Bram Moolenaar383f9bc2005-01-19 22:18:32 +0000134 :let r = call(Fn, mylist)
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000135
136
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00001371.3 Lists ~
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +0000138 *List* *Lists* *E686*
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000139A List is an ordered sequence of items. An item can be of any type. Items
140can be accessed by their index number. Items can be added and removed at any
141position in the sequence.
142
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000143
144List creation ~
145 *E696* *E697*
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000146A List is created with a comma separated list of items in square brackets.
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000147Examples: >
148 :let mylist = [1, two, 3, "four"]
149 :let emptylist = []
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000150
151An item can be any expression. Using a List for an item creates a
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +0000152List of Lists: >
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000153 :let nestlist = [[11, 12], [21, 22], [31, 32]]
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000154
155An extra comma after the last item is ignored.
156
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000157
158List index ~
159 *list-index* *E684*
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000160An item in the List can be accessed by putting the index in square brackets
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000161after the List. Indexes are zero-based, thus the first item has index zero. >
162 :let item = mylist[0] " get the first item: 1
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000163 :let item = mylist[2] " get the third item: 3
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000164
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000165When the resulting item is a list this can be repeated: >
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000166 :let item = nestlist[0][1] " get the first list, second item: 12
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000167<
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000168A negative index is counted from the end. Index -1 refers to the last item in
169the List, -2 to the last but one item, etc. >
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000170 :let last = mylist[-1] " get the last item: "four"
171
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000172To avoid an error for an invalid index use the |get()| function. When an item
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000173is not available it returns zero or the default value you specify: >
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000174 :echo get(mylist, idx)
175 :echo get(mylist, idx, "NONE")
176
177
178List concatenation ~
179
180Two lists can be concatenated with the "+" operator: >
181 :let longlist = mylist + [5, 6]
Bram Moolenaar383f9bc2005-01-19 22:18:32 +0000182 :let mylist += [7, 8]
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000183
184To prepend or append an item turn the item into a list by putting [] around
185it. To change a list in-place see |list-modification| below.
186
187
188Sublist ~
189
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000190A part of the List can be obtained by specifying the first and last index,
191separated by a colon in square brackets: >
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000192 :let shortlist = mylist[2:-1] " get List [3, "four"]
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000193
194Omitting the first index is similar to zero. Omitting the last index is
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +0000195similar to -1. >
Bram Moolenaar540d6e32005-01-09 21:20:18 +0000196 :let endlist = mylist[2:] " from item 2 to the end: [3, "four"]
197 :let shortlist = mylist[2:2] " List with one item: [3]
198 :let otherlist = mylist[:] " make a copy of the List
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000199
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +0000200If the first index is beyond the last item of the List or the second item is
201before the first item, the result is an empty list. There is no error
202message.
203
204If the second index is equal to or greater than the length of the list the
205length minus one is used: >
Bram Moolenaar9e54a0e2006-04-14 20:42:25 +0000206 :let mylist = [0, 1, 2, 3]
207 :echo mylist[2:8] " result: [2, 3]
208
Bram Moolenaara7fc0102005-05-18 22:17:12 +0000209NOTE: mylist[s:e] means using the variable "s:e" as index. Watch out for
210using a single letter variable before the ":". Insert a space when needed:
211mylist[s : e].
212
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000213
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000214List identity ~
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000215 *list-identity*
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000216When variable "aa" is a list and you assign it to another variable "bb", both
217variables refer to the same list. Thus changing the list "aa" will also
218change "bb": >
219 :let aa = [1, 2, 3]
220 :let bb = aa
221 :call add(aa, 4)
222 :echo bb
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000223< [1, 2, 3, 4]
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000224
225Making a copy of a list is done with the |copy()| function. Using [:] also
226works, as explained above. This creates a shallow copy of the list: Changing
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000227a list item in the list will also change the item in the copied list: >
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000228 :let aa = [[1, 'a'], 2, 3]
229 :let bb = copy(aa)
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000230 :call add(aa, 4)
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000231 :let aa[0][1] = 'aaa'
232 :echo aa
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000233< [[1, aaa], 2, 3, 4] >
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000234 :echo bb
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000235< [[1, aaa], 2, 3]
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000236
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000237To make a completely independent list use |deepcopy()|. This also makes a
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000238copy of the values in the list, recursively. Up to a hundred levels deep.
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000239
240The operator "is" can be used to check if two variables refer to the same
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000241List. "isnot" does the opposite. In contrast "==" compares if two lists have
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000242the same value. >
243 :let alist = [1, 2, 3]
244 :let blist = [1, 2, 3]
245 :echo alist is blist
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000246< 0 >
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000247 :echo alist == blist
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000248< 1
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000249
Bram Moolenaar9ba0eb82005-06-13 22:28:56 +0000250Note about comparing lists: Two lists are considered equal if they have the
251same length and all items compare equal, as with using "==". There is one
Bram Moolenaar7d1f5db2005-07-03 21:39:27 +0000252exception: When comparing a number with a string they are considered
253different. There is no automatic type conversion, as with using "==" on
254variables. Example: >
255 echo 4 == "4"
Bram Moolenaar9ba0eb82005-06-13 22:28:56 +0000256< 1 >
Bram Moolenaar7d1f5db2005-07-03 21:39:27 +0000257 echo [4] == ["4"]
Bram Moolenaar9ba0eb82005-06-13 22:28:56 +0000258< 0
259
Bram Moolenaar7d1f5db2005-07-03 21:39:27 +0000260Thus comparing Lists is more strict than comparing numbers and strings. You
261can compare simple values this way too by putting them in a string: >
262
263 :let a = 5
264 :let b = "5"
265 echo a == b
266< 1 >
267 echo [a] == [b]
268< 0
Bram Moolenaar9ba0eb82005-06-13 22:28:56 +0000269
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000270
271List unpack ~
272
273To unpack the items in a list to individual variables, put the variables in
274square brackets, like list items: >
275 :let [var1, var2] = mylist
276
277When the number of variables does not match the number of items in the list
278this produces an error. To handle any extra items from the list append ";"
279and a variable name: >
280 :let [var1, var2; rest] = mylist
281
282This works like: >
283 :let var1 = mylist[0]
284 :let var2 = mylist[1]
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +0000285 :let rest = mylist[2:]
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000286
287Except that there is no error if there are only two items. "rest" will be an
288empty list then.
289
290
291List modification ~
292 *list-modification*
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000293To change a specific item of a list use |:let| this way: >
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000294 :let list[4] = "four"
295 :let listlist[0][3] = item
296
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000297To change part of a list you can specify the first and last item to be
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000298modified. The value must at least have the number of items in the range: >
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000299 :let list[3:5] = [3, 4, 5]
300
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000301Adding and removing items from a list is done with functions. Here are a few
302examples: >
303 :call insert(list, 'a') " prepend item 'a'
304 :call insert(list, 'a', 3) " insert item 'a' before list[3]
305 :call add(list, "new") " append String item
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000306 :call add(list, [1, 2]) " append a List as one new item
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000307 :call extend(list, [1, 2]) " extend the list with two more items
308 :let i = remove(list, 3) " remove item 3
Bram Moolenaar9cd15162005-01-16 22:02:49 +0000309 :unlet list[3] " idem
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000310 :let l = remove(list, 3, -1) " remove items 3 to last item
Bram Moolenaar9cd15162005-01-16 22:02:49 +0000311 :unlet list[3 : ] " idem
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000312 :call filter(list, 'v:val !~ "x"') " remove items with an 'x'
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000313
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000314Changing the order of items in a list: >
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000315 :call sort(list) " sort a list alphabetically
316 :call reverse(list) " reverse the order of items
317
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000318
319For loop ~
320
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000321The |:for| loop executes commands for each item in a list. A variable is set
322to each item in the list in sequence. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000323 :for item in mylist
324 : call Doit(item)
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000325 :endfor
326
327This works like: >
328 :let index = 0
329 :while index < len(mylist)
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000330 : let item = mylist[index]
331 : :call Doit(item)
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000332 : let index = index + 1
333 :endwhile
334
335Note that all items in the list should be of the same type, otherwise this
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000336results in error |E706|. To avoid this |:unlet| the variable at the end of
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000337the loop.
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000338
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +0000339If all you want to do is modify each item in the list then the |map()|
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000340function will be a simpler method than a for loop.
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +0000341
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000342Just like the |:let| command, |:for| also accepts a list of variables. This
343requires the argument to be a list of lists. >
344 :for [lnum, col] in [[1, 3], [2, 8], [3, 0]]
345 : call Doit(lnum, col)
346 :endfor
347
348This works like a |:let| command is done for each list item. Again, the types
349must remain the same to avoid an error.
350
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000351It is also possible to put remaining items in a List variable: >
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000352 :for [i, j; rest] in listlist
353 : call Doit(i, j)
354 : if !empty(rest)
355 : echo "remainder: " . string(rest)
356 : endif
357 :endfor
358
359
360List functions ~
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000361 *E714*
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000362Functions that are useful with a List: >
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000363 :let r = call(funcname, list) " call a function with an argument list
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000364 :if empty(list) " check if list is empty
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000365 :let l = len(list) " number of items in list
366 :let big = max(list) " maximum value in list
367 :let small = min(list) " minimum value in list
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +0000368 :let xs = count(list, 'x') " count nr of times 'x' appears in list
369 :let i = index(list, 'x') " index of first 'x' in list
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000370 :let lines = getline(1, 10) " get ten text lines from buffer
371 :call append('$', lines) " append text lines in buffer
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +0000372 :let list = split("a b c") " create list from items in a string
373 :let string = join(list, ', ') " create string from list items
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000374 :let s = string(list) " String representation of list
375 :call map(list, '">> " . v:val') " prepend ">> " to each item
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000376
Bram Moolenaar0cb032e2005-04-23 20:52:00 +0000377Don't forget that a combination of features can make things simple. For
378example, to add up all the numbers in a list: >
379 :exe 'let sum = ' . join(nrlist, '+')
380
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000381
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00003821.4 Dictionaries ~
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000383 *Dictionaries* *Dictionary*
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000384A Dictionary is an associative array: Each entry has a key and a value. The
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000385entry can be located with the key. The entries are stored without a specific
386ordering.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000387
388
389Dictionary creation ~
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000390 *E720* *E721* *E722* *E723*
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000391A Dictionary is created with a comma separated list of entries in curly
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000392braces. Each entry has a key and a value, separated by a colon. Each key can
393only appear once. Examples: >
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000394 :let mydict = {1: 'one', 2: 'two', 3: 'three'}
395 :let emptydict = {}
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000396< *E713* *E716* *E717*
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000397A key is always a String. You can use a Number, it will be converted to a
398String automatically. Thus the String '4' and the number 4 will find the same
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000399entry. Note that the String '04' and the Number 04 are different, since the
400Number will be converted to the String '4'.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000401
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000402A value can be any expression. Using a Dictionary for a value creates a
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000403nested Dictionary: >
404 :let nestdict = {1: {11: 'a', 12: 'b'}, 2: {21: 'c'}}
405
406An extra comma after the last entry is ignored.
407
408
409Accessing entries ~
410
411The normal way to access an entry is by putting the key in square brackets: >
412 :let val = mydict["one"]
413 :let mydict["four"] = 4
414
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000415You can add new entries to an existing Dictionary this way, unlike Lists.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000416
417For keys that consist entirely of letters, digits and underscore the following
418form can be used |expr-entry|: >
419 :let val = mydict.one
420 :let mydict.four = 4
421
422Since an entry can be any type, also a List and a Dictionary, the indexing and
423key lookup can be repeated: >
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000424 :echo dict.key[idx].key
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000425
426
427Dictionary to List conversion ~
428
429You may want to loop over the entries in a dictionary. For this you need to
430turn the Dictionary into a List and pass it to |:for|.
431
432Most often you want to loop over the keys, using the |keys()| function: >
433 :for key in keys(mydict)
434 : echo key . ': ' . mydict[key]
435 :endfor
436
437The List of keys is unsorted. You may want to sort them first: >
438 :for key in sort(keys(mydict))
439
440To loop over the values use the |values()| function: >
441 :for v in values(mydict)
442 : echo "value: " . v
443 :endfor
444
445If you want both the key and the value use the |items()| function. It returns
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000446a List in which each item is a List with two items, the key and the value: >
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +0000447 :for [key, value] in items(mydict)
448 : echo key . ': ' . value
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000449 :endfor
450
451
452Dictionary identity ~
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +0000453 *dict-identity*
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000454Just like Lists you need to use |copy()| and |deepcopy()| to make a copy of a
455Dictionary. Otherwise, assignment results in referring to the same
456Dictionary: >
457 :let onedict = {'a': 1, 'b': 2}
458 :let adict = onedict
459 :let adict['a'] = 11
460 :echo onedict['a']
461 11
462
Bram Moolenaarf3bd51a2005-06-14 22:11:18 +0000463Two Dictionaries compare equal if all the key-value pairs compare equal. For
464more info see |list-identity|.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000465
466
467Dictionary modification ~
468 *dict-modification*
469To change an already existing entry of a Dictionary, or to add a new entry,
470use |:let| this way: >
471 :let dict[4] = "four"
472 :let dict['one'] = item
473
Bram Moolenaar9cd15162005-01-16 22:02:49 +0000474Removing an entry from a Dictionary is done with |remove()| or |:unlet|.
475Three ways to remove the entry with key "aaa" from dict: >
476 :let i = remove(dict, 'aaa')
477 :unlet dict.aaa
478 :unlet dict['aaa']
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000479
480Merging a Dictionary with another is done with |extend()|: >
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000481 :call extend(adict, bdict)
482This extends adict with all entries from bdict. Duplicate keys cause entries
483in adict to be overwritten. An optional third argument can change this.
Bram Moolenaar383f9bc2005-01-19 22:18:32 +0000484Note that the order of entries in a Dictionary is irrelevant, thus don't
485expect ":echo adict" to show the items from bdict after the older entries in
486adict.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000487
488Weeding out entries from a Dictionary can be done with |filter()|: >
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +0000489 :call filter(dict, 'v:val =~ "x"')
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000490This removes all entries from "dict" with a value not matching 'x'.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000491
492
493Dictionary function ~
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000494 *Dictionary-function* *self* *E725*
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000495When a function is defined with the "dict" attribute it can be used in a
496special way with a dictionary. Example: >
497 :function Mylen() dict
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000498 : return len(self.data)
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000499 :endfunction
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000500 :let mydict = {'data': [0, 1, 2, 3], 'len': function("Mylen")}
501 :echo mydict.len()
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000502
503This is like a method in object oriented programming. The entry in the
504Dictionary is a |Funcref|. The local variable "self" refers to the dictionary
505the function was invoked from.
506
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000507It is also possible to add a function without the "dict" attribute as a
508Funcref to a Dictionary, but the "self" variable is not available then.
509
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +0000510 *numbered-function* *anonymous-function*
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000511To avoid the extra name for the function it can be defined and directly
512assigned to a Dictionary in this way: >
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000513 :let mydict = {'data': [0, 1, 2, 3]}
514 :function mydict.len() dict
515 : return len(self.data)
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000516 :endfunction
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000517 :echo mydict.len()
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000518
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000519The function will then get a number and the value of dict.len is a |Funcref|
520that references this function. The function can only be used through a
521|Funcref|. It will automatically be deleted when there is no |Funcref|
522remaining that refers to it.
523
524It is not necessary to use the "dict" attribute for a numbered function.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000525
526
527Functions for Dictionaries ~
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000528 *E715*
529Functions that can be used with a Dictionary: >
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000530 :if has_key(dict, 'foo') " TRUE if dict has entry with key "foo"
531 :if empty(dict) " TRUE if dict is empty
532 :let l = len(dict) " number of items in dict
533 :let big = max(dict) " maximum value in dict
534 :let small = min(dict) " minimum value in dict
535 :let xs = count(dict, 'x') " count nr of times 'x' appears in dict
536 :let s = string(dict) " String representation of dict
537 :call map(dict, '">> " . v:val') " prepend ">> " to each item
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000538
539
5401.5 More about variables ~
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000541 *more-variables*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000542If you need to know the type of a variable or expression, use the |type()|
543function.
544
545When the '!' flag is included in the 'viminfo' option, global variables that
546start with an uppercase letter, and don't contain a lowercase letter, are
547stored in the viminfo file |viminfo-file|.
548
549When the 'sessionoptions' option contains "global", global variables that
550start with an uppercase letter and contain at least one lowercase letter are
551stored in the session file |session-file|.
552
553variable name can be stored where ~
554my_var_6 not
555My_Var_6 session file
556MY_VAR_6 viminfo file
557
558
559It's possible to form a variable name with curly braces, see
560|curly-braces-names|.
561
562==============================================================================
5632. Expression syntax *expression-syntax*
564
565Expression syntax summary, from least to most significant:
566
567|expr1| expr2 ? expr1 : expr1 if-then-else
568
569|expr2| expr3 || expr3 .. logical OR
570
571|expr3| expr4 && expr4 .. logical AND
572
573|expr4| expr5 == expr5 equal
574 expr5 != expr5 not equal
575 expr5 > expr5 greater than
576 expr5 >= expr5 greater than or equal
577 expr5 < expr5 smaller than
578 expr5 <= expr5 smaller than or equal
579 expr5 =~ expr5 regexp matches
580 expr5 !~ expr5 regexp doesn't match
581
582 expr5 ==? expr5 equal, ignoring case
583 expr5 ==# expr5 equal, match case
584 etc. As above, append ? for ignoring case, # for
585 matching case
586
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000587 expr5 is expr5 same |List| instance
588 expr5 isnot expr5 different |List| instance
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +0000589
590|expr5| expr6 + expr6 .. number addition or list concatenation
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000591 expr6 - expr6 .. number subtraction
592 expr6 . expr6 .. string concatenation
593
594|expr6| expr7 * expr7 .. number multiplication
595 expr7 / expr7 .. number division
596 expr7 % expr7 .. number modulo
597
598|expr7| ! expr7 logical NOT
599 - expr7 unary minus
600 + expr7 unary plus
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000601
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000602
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000603|expr8| expr8[expr1] byte of a String or item of a |List|
604 expr8[expr1 : expr1] substring of a String or sublist of a |List|
605 expr8.name entry in a |Dictionary|
606 expr8(expr1, ...) function call with |Funcref| variable
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000607
608|expr9| number number constant
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +0000609 "string" string constant, backslash is special
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000610 'string' string constant, ' is doubled
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000611 [expr1, ...] |List|
612 {expr1: expr1, ...} |Dictionary|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000613 &option option value
614 (expr1) nested expression
615 variable internal variable
616 va{ria}ble internal variable with curly braces
617 $VAR environment variable
618 @r contents of register 'r'
619 function(expr1, ...) function call
620 func{ti}on(expr1, ...) function call with curly braces
621
622
623".." indicates that the operations in this level can be concatenated.
624Example: >
625 &nu || &list && &shell == "csh"
626
627All expressions within one level are parsed from left to right.
628
629
630expr1 *expr1* *E109*
631-----
632
633expr2 ? expr1 : expr1
634
635The expression before the '?' is evaluated to a number. If it evaluates to
636non-zero, the result is the value of the expression between the '?' and ':',
637otherwise the result is the value of the expression after the ':'.
638Example: >
639 :echo lnum == 1 ? "top" : lnum
640
641Since the first expression is an "expr2", it cannot contain another ?:. The
642other two expressions can, thus allow for recursive use of ?:.
643Example: >
644 :echo lnum == 1 ? "top" : lnum == 1000 ? "last" : lnum
645
646To keep this readable, using |line-continuation| is suggested: >
647 :echo lnum == 1
648 :\ ? "top"
649 :\ : lnum == 1000
650 :\ ? "last"
651 :\ : lnum
652
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +0000653You should always put a space before the ':', otherwise it can be mistaken for
654use in a variable such as "a:1".
655
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000656
657expr2 and expr3 *expr2* *expr3*
658---------------
659
660 *expr-barbar* *expr-&&*
661The "||" and "&&" operators take one argument on each side. The arguments
662are (converted to) Numbers. The result is:
663
664 input output ~
665n1 n2 n1 || n2 n1 && n2 ~
666zero zero zero zero
667zero non-zero non-zero zero
668non-zero zero non-zero zero
669non-zero non-zero non-zero non-zero
670
671The operators can be concatenated, for example: >
672
673 &nu || &list && &shell == "csh"
674
675Note that "&&" takes precedence over "||", so this has the meaning of: >
676
677 &nu || (&list && &shell == "csh")
678
679Once the result is known, the expression "short-circuits", that is, further
680arguments are not evaluated. This is like what happens in C. For example: >
681
682 let a = 1
683 echo a || b
684
685This is valid even if there is no variable called "b" because "a" is non-zero,
686so the result must be non-zero. Similarly below: >
687
688 echo exists("b") && b == "yes"
689
690This is valid whether "b" has been defined or not. The second clause will
691only be evaluated if "b" has been defined.
692
693
694expr4 *expr4*
695-----
696
697expr5 {cmp} expr5
698
699Compare two expr5 expressions, resulting in a 0 if it evaluates to false, or 1
700if it evaluates to true.
701
702 *expr-==* *expr-!=* *expr->* *expr->=*
703 *expr-<* *expr-<=* *expr-=~* *expr-!~*
704 *expr-==#* *expr-!=#* *expr->#* *expr->=#*
705 *expr-<#* *expr-<=#* *expr-=~#* *expr-!~#*
706 *expr-==?* *expr-!=?* *expr->?* *expr->=?*
707 *expr-<?* *expr-<=?* *expr-=~?* *expr-!~?*
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +0000708 *expr-is*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000709 use 'ignorecase' match case ignore case ~
710equal == ==# ==?
711not equal != !=# !=?
712greater than > ># >?
713greater than or equal >= >=# >=?
714smaller than < <# <?
715smaller than or equal <= <=# <=?
716regexp matches =~ =~# =~?
717regexp doesn't match !~ !~# !~?
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +0000718same instance is
719different instance isnot
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000720
721Examples:
722"abc" ==# "Abc" evaluates to 0
723"abc" ==? "Abc" evaluates to 1
724"abc" == "Abc" evaluates to 1 if 'ignorecase' is set, 0 otherwise
725
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000726 *E691* *E692*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000727A |List| can only be compared with a |List| and only "equal", "not equal" and
728"is" can be used. This compares the values of the list, recursively.
729Ignoring case means case is ignored when comparing item values.
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +0000730
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000731 *E735* *E736*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000732A |Dictionary| can only be compared with a |Dictionary| and only "equal", "not
733equal" and "is" can be used. This compares the key/values of the |Dictionary|
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +0000734recursively. Ignoring case means case is ignored when comparing item values.
735
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +0000736 *E693* *E694*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000737A |Funcref| can only be compared with a |Funcref| and only "equal" and "not
738equal" can be used. Case is never ignored.
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +0000739
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000740When using "is" or "isnot" with a |List| this checks if the expressions are
741referring to the same |List| instance. A copy of a |List| is different from
742the original |List|. When using "is" without a |List| it is equivalent to
743using "equal", using "isnot" equivalent to using "not equal". Except that a
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +0000744different type means the values are different. "4 == '4'" is true, "4 is '4'"
745is false.
746
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000747When comparing a String with a Number, the String is converted to a Number,
748and the comparison is done on Numbers. This means that "0 == 'x'" is TRUE,
749because 'x' converted to a Number is zero.
750
751When comparing two Strings, this is done with strcmp() or stricmp(). This
752results in the mathematical difference (comparing byte values), not
753necessarily the alphabetical difference in the local language.
754
755When using the operators with a trailing '#", or the short version and
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +0000756'ignorecase' is off, the comparing is done with strcmp(): case matters.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000757
758When using the operators with a trailing '?', or the short version and
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +0000759'ignorecase' is set, the comparing is done with stricmp(): case is ignored.
760
761'smartcase' is not used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000762
763The "=~" and "!~" operators match the lefthand argument with the righthand
764argument, which is used as a pattern. See |pattern| for what a pattern is.
765This matching is always done like 'magic' was set and 'cpoptions' is empty, no
766matter what the actual value of 'magic' or 'cpoptions' is. This makes scripts
767portable. To avoid backslashes in the regexp pattern to be doubled, use a
768single-quote string, see |literal-string|.
769Since a string is considered to be a single line, a multi-line pattern
770(containing \n, backslash-n) will not match. However, a literal NL character
771can be matched like an ordinary character. Examples:
772 "foo\nbar" =~ "\n" evaluates to 1
773 "foo\nbar" =~ "\\n" evaluates to 0
774
775
776expr5 and expr6 *expr5* *expr6*
777---------------
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000778expr6 + expr6 .. Number addition or |List| concatenation *expr-+*
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +0000779expr6 - expr6 .. Number subtraction *expr--*
780expr6 . expr6 .. String concatenation *expr-.*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000781
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +0000782For |Lists| only "+" is possible and then both expr6 must be a list. The
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000783result is a new list with the two lists Concatenated.
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +0000784
785expr7 * expr7 .. number multiplication *expr-star*
786expr7 / expr7 .. number division *expr-/*
787expr7 % expr7 .. number modulo *expr-%*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000788
789For all, except ".", Strings are converted to Numbers.
790
791Note the difference between "+" and ".":
792 "123" + "456" = 579
793 "123" . "456" = "123456"
794
795When the righthand side of '/' is zero, the result is 0x7fffffff.
796When the righthand side of '%' is zero, the result is 0.
797
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000798None of these work for |Funcref|s.
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +0000799
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000800
801expr7 *expr7*
802-----
803! expr7 logical NOT *expr-!*
804- expr7 unary minus *expr-unary--*
805+ expr7 unary plus *expr-unary-+*
806
807For '!' non-zero becomes zero, zero becomes one.
808For '-' the sign of the number is changed.
809For '+' the number is unchanged.
810
811A String will be converted to a Number first.
812
813These three can be repeated and mixed. Examples:
814 !-1 == 0
815 !!8 == 1
816 --9 == 9
817
818
819expr8 *expr8*
820-----
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000821expr8[expr1] item of String or |List| *expr-[]* *E111*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000822
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000823If expr8 is a Number or String this results in a String that contains the
824expr1'th single byte from expr8. expr8 is used as a String, expr1 as a
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000825Number. Note that this doesn't recognize multi-byte encodings.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000826
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000827Index zero gives the first character. This is like it works in C. Careful:
828text column numbers start with one! Example, to get the character under the
829cursor: >
Bram Moolenaar61660ea2006-04-07 21:40:07 +0000830 :let c = getline(".")[col(".") - 1]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000831
832If the length of the String is less than the index, the result is an empty
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000833String. A negative index always results in an empty string (reason: backwards
834compatibility). Use [-1:] to get the last byte.
835
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000836If expr8 is a |List| then it results the item at index expr1. See |list-index|
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000837for possible index values. If the index is out of range this results in an
838error. Example: >
839 :let item = mylist[-1] " get last item
840
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000841Generally, if a |List| index is equal to or higher than the length of the
842|List|, or more negative than the length of the |List|, this results in an
843error.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000844
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000845
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000846expr8[expr1a : expr1b] substring or sublist *expr-[:]*
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000847
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000848If expr8 is a Number or String this results in the substring with the bytes
849from expr1a to and including expr1b. expr8 is used as a String, expr1a and
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000850expr1b are used as a Number. Note that this doesn't recognize multi-byte
851encodings.
852
853If expr1a is omitted zero is used. If expr1b is omitted the length of the
854string minus one is used.
855
856A negative number can be used to measure from the end of the string. -1 is
857the last character, -2 the last but one, etc.
858
859If an index goes out of range for the string characters are omitted. If
860expr1b is smaller than expr1a the result is an empty string.
861
862Examples: >
863 :let c = name[-1:] " last byte of a string
864 :let c = name[-2:-2] " last but one byte of a string
865 :let s = line(".")[4:] " from the fifth byte to the end
866 :let s = s[:-3] " remove last two bytes
867
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000868If expr8 is a |List| this results in a new |List| with the items indicated by
869the indexes expr1a and expr1b. This works like with a String, as explained
870just above, except that indexes out of range cause an error. Examples: >
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +0000871 :let l = mylist[:3] " first four items
872 :let l = mylist[4:4] " List with one item
873 :let l = mylist[:] " shallow copy of a List
874
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000875Using expr8[expr1] or expr8[expr1a : expr1b] on a |Funcref| results in an
876error.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000877
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000878
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000879expr8.name entry in a |Dictionary| *expr-entry*
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000880
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000881If expr8 is a |Dictionary| and it is followed by a dot, then the following
882name will be used as a key in the |Dictionary|. This is just like:
883expr8[name].
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000884
885The name must consist of alphanumeric characters, just like a variable name,
886but it may start with a number. Curly braces cannot be used.
887
888There must not be white space before or after the dot.
889
890Examples: >
891 :let dict = {"one": 1, 2: "two"}
892 :echo dict.one
893 :echo dict .2
894
895Note that the dot is also used for String concatenation. To avoid confusion
896always put spaces around the dot for String concatenation.
897
898
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +0000899expr8(expr1, ...) |Funcref| function call
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +0000900
901When expr8 is a |Funcref| type variable, invoke the function it refers to.
902
903
904
905 *expr9*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000906number
907------
908number number constant *expr-number*
909
910Decimal, Hexadecimal (starting with 0x or 0X), or Octal (starting with 0).
911
912
913string *expr-string* *E114*
914------
915"string" string constant *expr-quote*
916
917Note that double quotes are used.
918
919A string constant accepts these special characters:
920\... three-digit octal number (e.g., "\316")
921\.. two-digit octal number (must be followed by non-digit)
922\. one-digit octal number (must be followed by non-digit)
923\x.. byte specified with two hex numbers (e.g., "\x1f")
924\x. byte specified with one hex number (must be followed by non-hex char)
925\X.. same as \x..
926\X. same as \x.
927\u.... character specified with up to 4 hex numbers, stored according to the
928 current value of 'encoding' (e.g., "\u02a4")
929\U.... same as \u....
930\b backspace <BS>
931\e escape <Esc>
932\f formfeed <FF>
933\n newline <NL>
934\r return <CR>
935\t tab <Tab>
936\\ backslash
937\" double quote
938\<xxx> Special key named "xxx". e.g. "\<C-W>" for CTRL-W.
939
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +0000940Note that "\xff" is stored as the byte 255, which may be invalid in some
941encodings. Use "\u00ff" to store character 255 according to the current value
942of 'encoding'.
943
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000944Note that "\000" and "\x00" force the end of the string.
945
946
947literal-string *literal-string* *E115*
948---------------
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +0000949'string' string constant *expr-'*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000950
951Note that single quotes are used.
952
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +0000953This string is taken as it is. No backslashes are removed or have a special
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +0000954meaning. The only exception is that two quotes stand for one quote.
Bram Moolenaar3fdfa4a2004-10-07 21:02:47 +0000955
956Single quoted strings are useful for patterns, so that backslashes do not need
957to be doubled. These two commands are equivalent: >
958 if a =~ "\\s*"
959 if a =~ '\s*'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000960
961
962option *expr-option* *E112* *E113*
963------
964&option option value, local value if possible
965&g:option global option value
966&l:option local option value
967
968Examples: >
969 echo "tabstop is " . &tabstop
970 if &insertmode
971
972Any option name can be used here. See |options|. When using the local value
973and there is no buffer-local or window-local value, the global value is used
974anyway.
975
976
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +0000977register *expr-register* *@r*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000978--------
979@r contents of register 'r'
980
981The result is the contents of the named register, as a single string.
982Newlines are inserted where required. To get the contents of the unnamed
Bram Moolenaare7566042005-06-17 22:00:15 +0000983register use @" or @@. See |registers| for an explanation of the available
984registers.
985
986When using the '=' register you get the expression itself, not what it
987evaluates to. Use |eval()| to evaluate it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +0000988
989
990nesting *expr-nesting* *E110*
991-------
992(expr1) nested expression
993
994
995environment variable *expr-env*
996--------------------
997$VAR environment variable
998
999The String value of any environment variable. When it is not defined, the
1000result is an empty string.
1001 *expr-env-expand*
1002Note that there is a difference between using $VAR directly and using
1003expand("$VAR"). Using it directly will only expand environment variables that
1004are known inside the current Vim session. Using expand() will first try using
1005the environment variables known inside the current Vim session. If that
1006fails, a shell will be used to expand the variable. This can be slow, but it
1007does expand all variables that the shell knows about. Example: >
1008 :echo $version
1009 :echo expand("$version")
1010The first one probably doesn't echo anything, the second echoes the $version
1011variable (if your shell supports it).
1012
1013
1014internal variable *expr-variable*
1015-----------------
1016variable internal variable
1017See below |internal-variables|.
1018
1019
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00001020function call *expr-function* *E116* *E118* *E119* *E120*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001021-------------
1022function(expr1, ...) function call
1023See below |functions|.
1024
1025
1026==============================================================================
10273. Internal variable *internal-variables* *E121*
1028 *E461*
1029An internal variable name can be made up of letters, digits and '_'. But it
1030cannot start with a digit. It's also possible to use curly braces, see
1031|curly-braces-names|.
1032
1033An internal variable is created with the ":let" command |:let|.
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00001034An internal variable is explicitly destroyed with the ":unlet" command
1035|:unlet|.
1036Using a name that is not an internal variable or refers to a variable that has
1037been destroyed results in an error.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001038
1039There are several name spaces for variables. Which one is to be used is
1040specified by what is prepended:
1041
1042 (nothing) In a function: local to a function; otherwise: global
1043|buffer-variable| b: Local to the current buffer.
1044|window-variable| w: Local to the current window.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001045|tabpage-variable| t: Local to the current tab page.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001046|global-variable| g: Global.
1047|local-variable| l: Local to a function.
1048|script-variable| s: Local to a |:source|'ed Vim script.
1049|function-argument| a: Function argument (only inside a function).
1050|vim-variable| v: Global, predefined by Vim.
1051
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00001052The scope name by itself can be used as a |Dictionary|. For example, to
1053delete all script-local variables: >
Bram Moolenaar8f999f12005-01-25 22:12:55 +00001054 :for k in keys(s:)
1055 : unlet s:[k]
1056 :endfor
1057<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001058 *buffer-variable* *b:var*
1059A variable name that is preceded with "b:" is local to the current buffer.
1060Thus you can have several "b:foo" variables, one for each buffer.
1061This kind of variable is deleted when the buffer is wiped out or deleted with
1062|:bdelete|.
1063
1064One local buffer variable is predefined:
1065 *b:changedtick-variable* *changetick*
1066b:changedtick The total number of changes to the current buffer. It is
1067 incremented for each change. An undo command is also a change
1068 in this case. This can be used to perform an action only when
1069 the buffer has changed. Example: >
1070 :if my_changedtick != b:changedtick
1071 : let my_changedtick = b:changedtick
1072 : call My_Update()
1073 :endif
1074<
1075 *window-variable* *w:var*
1076A variable name that is preceded with "w:" is local to the current window. It
1077is deleted when the window is closed.
1078
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001079 *tabpage-variable* *t:var*
1080A variable name that is preceded with "t:" is local to the current tab page,
1081It is deleted when the tab page is closed. {not available when compiled
1082without the +windows feature}
1083
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001084 *global-variable* *g:var*
1085Inside functions global variables are accessed with "g:". Omitting this will
1086access a variable local to a function. But "g:" can also be used in any other
1087place if you like.
1088
1089 *local-variable* *l:var*
1090Inside functions local variables are accessed without prepending anything.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00001091But you can also prepend "l:" if you like. However, without prepending "l:"
1092you may run into reserved variable names. For example "count". By itself it
1093refers to "v:count". Using "l:count" you can have a local variable with the
1094same name.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001095
1096 *script-variable* *s:var*
1097In a Vim script variables starting with "s:" can be used. They cannot be
1098accessed from outside of the scripts, thus are local to the script.
1099
1100They can be used in:
1101- commands executed while the script is sourced
1102- functions defined in the script
1103- autocommands defined in the script
1104- functions and autocommands defined in functions and autocommands which were
1105 defined in the script (recursively)
1106- user defined commands defined in the script
1107Thus not in:
1108- other scripts sourced from this one
1109- mappings
1110- etc.
1111
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00001112Script variables can be used to avoid conflicts with global variable names.
1113Take this example: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001114
1115 let s:counter = 0
1116 function MyCounter()
1117 let s:counter = s:counter + 1
1118 echo s:counter
1119 endfunction
1120 command Tick call MyCounter()
1121
1122You can now invoke "Tick" from any script, and the "s:counter" variable in
1123that script will not be changed, only the "s:counter" in the script where
1124"Tick" was defined is used.
1125
1126Another example that does the same: >
1127
1128 let s:counter = 0
1129 command Tick let s:counter = s:counter + 1 | echo s:counter
1130
1131When calling a function and invoking a user-defined command, the context for
Bram Moolenaar69a7cb42004-06-20 12:51:53 +00001132script variables is set to the script where the function or command was
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001133defined.
1134
1135The script variables are also available when a function is defined inside a
1136function that is defined in a script. Example: >
1137
1138 let s:counter = 0
1139 function StartCounting(incr)
1140 if a:incr
1141 function MyCounter()
1142 let s:counter = s:counter + 1
1143 endfunction
1144 else
1145 function MyCounter()
1146 let s:counter = s:counter - 1
1147 endfunction
1148 endif
1149 endfunction
1150
1151This defines the MyCounter() function either for counting up or counting down
1152when calling StartCounting(). It doesn't matter from where StartCounting() is
1153called, the s:counter variable will be accessible in MyCounter().
1154
1155When the same script is sourced again it will use the same script variables.
1156They will remain valid as long as Vim is running. This can be used to
1157maintain a counter: >
1158
1159 if !exists("s:counter")
1160 let s:counter = 1
1161 echo "script executed for the first time"
1162 else
1163 let s:counter = s:counter + 1
1164 echo "script executed " . s:counter . " times now"
1165 endif
1166
1167Note that this means that filetype plugins don't get a different set of script
1168variables for each buffer. Use local buffer variables instead |b:var|.
1169
1170
1171Predefined Vim variables: *vim-variable* *v:var*
1172
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001173 *v:beval_col* *beval_col-variable*
1174v:beval_col The number of the column, over which the mouse pointer is.
1175 This is the byte index in the |v:beval_lnum| line.
1176 Only valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
1177
1178 *v:beval_bufnr* *beval_bufnr-variable*
1179v:beval_bufnr The number of the buffer, over which the mouse pointer is. Only
1180 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
1181
1182 *v:beval_lnum* *beval_lnum-variable*
1183v:beval_lnum The number of the line, over which the mouse pointer is. Only
1184 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
1185
1186 *v:beval_text* *beval_text-variable*
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00001187v:beval_text The text under or after the mouse pointer. Usually a word as
1188 it is useful for debugging a C program. 'iskeyword' applies,
1189 but a dot and "->" before the position is included. When on a
1190 ']' the text before it is used, including the matching '[' and
Bram Moolenaare4efc3b2005-03-07 23:16:51 +00001191 word before it. When on a Visual area within one line the
1192 highlighted text is used.
1193 Only valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
1194
1195 *v:beval_winnr* *beval_winnr-variable*
1196v:beval_winnr The number of the window, over which the mouse pointer is. Only
1197 valid while evaluating the 'balloonexpr' option.
1198
Bram Moolenaarf193fff2006-04-27 00:02:13 +00001199 *v:char* *char-variable*
1200v:char Argument for evaluating 'formatexpr'.
1201
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001202 *v:charconvert_from* *charconvert_from-variable*
1203v:charconvert_from
1204 The name of the character encoding of a file to be converted.
1205 Only valid while evaluating the 'charconvert' option.
1206
1207 *v:charconvert_to* *charconvert_to-variable*
1208v:charconvert_to
1209 The name of the character encoding of a file after conversion.
1210 Only valid while evaluating the 'charconvert' option.
1211
1212 *v:cmdarg* *cmdarg-variable*
1213v:cmdarg This variable is used for two purposes:
1214 1. The extra arguments given to a file read/write command.
1215 Currently these are "++enc=" and "++ff=". This variable is
1216 set before an autocommand event for a file read/write
1217 command is triggered. There is a leading space to make it
1218 possible to append this variable directly after the
1219 read/write command. Note: The "+cmd" argument isn't
1220 included here, because it will be executed anyway.
1221 2. When printing a PostScript file with ":hardcopy" this is
1222 the argument for the ":hardcopy" command. This can be used
1223 in 'printexpr'.
1224
1225 *v:cmdbang* *cmdbang-variable*
1226v:cmdbang Set like v:cmdarg for a file read/write command. When a "!"
1227 was used the value is 1, otherwise it is 0. Note that this
1228 can only be used in autocommands. For user commands |<bang>|
1229 can be used.
1230
1231 *v:count* *count-variable*
1232v:count The count given for the last Normal mode command. Can be used
1233 to get the count before a mapping. Read-only. Example: >
1234 :map _x :<C-U>echo "the count is " . v:count<CR>
1235< Note: The <C-U> is required to remove the line range that you
1236 get when typing ':' after a count.
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00001237 Also used for evaluating the 'formatexpr' option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001238 "count" also works, for backwards compatibility.
1239
1240 *v:count1* *count1-variable*
1241v:count1 Just like "v:count", but defaults to one when no count is
1242 used.
1243
1244 *v:ctype* *ctype-variable*
1245v:ctype The current locale setting for characters of the runtime
1246 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the
1247 current locale encoding. Technical: it's the value of
1248 LC_CTYPE. When not using a locale the value is "C".
1249 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language|
1250 command.
1251 See |multi-lang|.
1252
1253 *v:dying* *dying-variable*
1254v:dying Normally zero. When a deadly signal is caught it's set to
1255 one. When multiple signals are caught the number increases.
1256 Can be used in an autocommand to check if Vim didn't
1257 terminate normally. {only works on Unix}
1258 Example: >
1259 :au VimLeave * if v:dying | echo "\nAAAAaaaarrrggghhhh!!!\n" | endif
1260<
1261 *v:errmsg* *errmsg-variable*
1262v:errmsg Last given error message. It's allowed to set this variable.
1263 Example: >
1264 :let v:errmsg = ""
1265 :silent! next
1266 :if v:errmsg != ""
1267 : ... handle error
1268< "errmsg" also works, for backwards compatibility.
1269
1270 *v:exception* *exception-variable*
1271v:exception The value of the exception most recently caught and not
1272 finished. See also |v:throwpoint| and |throw-variables|.
1273 Example: >
1274 :try
1275 : throw "oops"
1276 :catch /.*/
1277 : echo "caught" v:exception
1278 :endtry
1279< Output: "caught oops".
1280
Bram Moolenaar19a09a12005-03-04 23:39:37 +00001281 *v:fcs_reason* *fcs_reason-variable*
1282v:fcs_reason The reason why the |FileChangedShell| event was triggered.
1283 Can be used in an autocommand to decide what to do and/or what
1284 to set v:fcs_choice to. Possible values:
1285 deleted file no longer exists
1286 conflict file contents, mode or timestamp was
1287 changed and buffer is modified
1288 changed file contents has changed
1289 mode mode of file changed
1290 time only file timestamp changed
1291
1292 *v:fcs_choice* *fcs_choice-variable*
1293v:fcs_choice What should happen after a |FileChangedShell| event was
1294 triggered. Can be used in an autocommand to tell Vim what to
1295 do with the affected buffer:
1296 reload Reload the buffer (does not work if
1297 the file was deleted).
1298 ask Ask the user what to do, as if there
1299 was no autocommand. Except that when
1300 only the timestamp changed nothing
1301 will happen.
1302 <empty> Nothing, the autocommand should do
1303 everything that needs to be done.
1304 The default is empty. If another (invalid) value is used then
1305 Vim behaves like it is empty, there is no warning message.
1306
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001307 *v:fname_in* *fname_in-variable*
Bram Moolenaar4e330bb2005-12-07 21:04:31 +00001308v:fname_in The name of the input file. Valid while evaluating:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001309 option used for ~
1310 'charconvert' file to be converted
1311 'diffexpr' original file
1312 'patchexpr' original file
1313 'printexpr' file to be printed
Bram Moolenaar2c7a29c2005-12-12 22:02:31 +00001314 And set to the swap file name for |SwapExists|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001315
1316 *v:fname_out* *fname_out-variable*
1317v:fname_out The name of the output file. Only valid while
1318 evaluating:
1319 option used for ~
1320 'charconvert' resulting converted file (*)
1321 'diffexpr' output of diff
1322 'patchexpr' resulting patched file
1323 (*) When doing conversion for a write command (e.g., ":w
1324 file") it will be equal to v:fname_in. When doing conversion
1325 for a read command (e.g., ":e file") it will be a temporary
1326 file and different from v:fname_in.
1327
1328 *v:fname_new* *fname_new-variable*
1329v:fname_new The name of the new version of the file. Only valid while
1330 evaluating 'diffexpr'.
1331
1332 *v:fname_diff* *fname_diff-variable*
1333v:fname_diff The name of the diff (patch) file. Only valid while
1334 evaluating 'patchexpr'.
1335
1336 *v:folddashes* *folddashes-variable*
1337v:folddashes Used for 'foldtext': dashes representing foldlevel of a closed
1338 fold.
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001339 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001340
1341 *v:foldlevel* *foldlevel-variable*
1342v:foldlevel Used for 'foldtext': foldlevel of closed fold.
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001343 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001344
1345 *v:foldend* *foldend-variable*
1346v:foldend Used for 'foldtext': last line of closed fold.
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001347 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001348
1349 *v:foldstart* *foldstart-variable*
1350v:foldstart Used for 'foldtext': first line of closed fold.
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001351 Read-only in the |sandbox|. |fold-foldtext|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001352
Bram Moolenaar843ee412004-06-30 16:16:41 +00001353 *v:insertmode* *insertmode-variable*
1354v:insertmode Used for the |InsertEnter| and |InsertChange| autocommand
1355 events. Values:
1356 i Insert mode
1357 r Replace mode
1358 v Virtual Replace mode
1359
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00001360 *v:key* *key-variable*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00001361v:key Key of the current item of a |Dictionary|. Only valid while
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00001362 evaluating the expression used with |map()| and |filter()|.
1363 Read-only.
1364
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001365 *v:lang* *lang-variable*
1366v:lang The current locale setting for messages of the runtime
1367 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the
1368 current language. Technical: it's the value of LC_MESSAGES.
1369 The value is system dependent.
1370 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language|
1371 command.
1372 It can be different from |v:ctype| when messages are desired
1373 in a different language than what is used for character
1374 encoding. See |multi-lang|.
1375
1376 *v:lc_time* *lc_time-variable*
1377v:lc_time The current locale setting for time messages of the runtime
1378 environment. This allows Vim scripts to be aware of the
1379 current language. Technical: it's the value of LC_TIME.
1380 This variable can not be set directly, use the |:language|
1381 command. See |multi-lang|.
1382
1383 *v:lnum* *lnum-variable*
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001384v:lnum Line number for the 'foldexpr' |fold-expr| and 'indentexpr'
Bram Moolenaar57657d82006-04-21 22:12:41 +00001385 expressions, tab page number for 'guitablabel' and
1386 'guitabtooltip'. Only valid while one of these expressions is
1387 being evaluated. Read-only when in the |sandbox|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001388
Bram Moolenaar219b8702006-11-01 14:32:36 +00001389 *v:mouse_win* *mouse_win-variable*
1390v:mouse_win Window number for a mouse click obtained with |getchar()|.
1391 First window has number 1, like with |winnr()|. The value is
1392 zero when there was no mouse button click.
1393
1394 *v:mouse_lnum* *mouse_lnum-variable*
1395v:mouse_lnum Line number for a mouse click obtained with |getchar()|.
1396 This is the text line number, not the screen line number. The
1397 value is zero when there was no mouse button click.
1398
1399 *v:mouse_col* *mouse_col-variable*
1400v:mouse_col Column number for a mouse click obtained with |getchar()|.
1401 This is the screen column number, like with |virtcol()|. The
1402 value is zero when there was no mouse button click.
1403
Bram Moolenaar8af1fbf2008-01-05 12:35:21 +00001404 *v:operator* *operator-variable*
1405v:operator The last operator given in Normal mode. This is a single
1406 character except for commands starting with <g> or <z>,
1407 in which case it is two characters. Best used alongside
1408 |v:prevcount| and |v:register|. Useful if you want to cancel
1409 Operator-pending mode and then use the operator, e.g.: >
1410 :omap O <Esc>:call MyMotion(v:operator)<CR>
1411< The value remains set until another operator is entered, thus
1412 don't expect it to be empty.
1413 v:operator is not set for |:delete|, |:yank| or other Ex
1414 commands.
1415 Read-only.
1416
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001417 *v:prevcount* *prevcount-variable*
1418v:prevcount The count given for the last but one Normal mode command.
1419 This is the v:count value of the previous command. Useful if
Bram Moolenaar8af1fbf2008-01-05 12:35:21 +00001420 you want to cancel Visual or Operator-pending mode and then
1421 use the count, e.g.: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001422 :vmap % <Esc>:call MyFilter(v:prevcount)<CR>
1423< Read-only.
1424
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00001425 *v:profiling* *profiling-variable*
1426v:profiling Normally zero. Set to one after using ":profile start".
1427 See |profiling|.
1428
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001429 *v:progname* *progname-variable*
1430v:progname Contains the name (with path removed) with which Vim was
1431 invoked. Allows you to do special initialisations for "view",
1432 "evim" etc., or any other name you might symlink to Vim.
1433 Read-only.
1434
1435 *v:register* *register-variable*
1436v:register The name of the register supplied to the last normal mode
1437 command. Empty if none were supplied. |getreg()| |setreg()|
1438
Bram Moolenaar1c7715d2005-10-03 22:02:18 +00001439 *v:scrollstart* *scrollstart-variable*
1440v:scrollstart String describing the script or function that caused the
1441 screen to scroll up. It's only set when it is empty, thus the
1442 first reason is remembered. It is set to "Unknown" for a
1443 typed command.
1444 This can be used to find out why your script causes the
1445 hit-enter prompt.
1446
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001447 *v:servername* *servername-variable*
1448v:servername The resulting registered |x11-clientserver| name if any.
1449 Read-only.
1450
1451 *v:shell_error* *shell_error-variable*
1452v:shell_error Result of the last shell command. When non-zero, the last
1453 shell command had an error. When zero, there was no problem.
1454 This only works when the shell returns the error code to Vim.
1455 The value -1 is often used when the command could not be
1456 executed. Read-only.
1457 Example: >
1458 :!mv foo bar
1459 :if v:shell_error
1460 : echo 'could not rename "foo" to "bar"!'
1461 :endif
1462< "shell_error" also works, for backwards compatibility.
1463
1464 *v:statusmsg* *statusmsg-variable*
1465v:statusmsg Last given status message. It's allowed to set this variable.
1466
Bram Moolenaar4e330bb2005-12-07 21:04:31 +00001467 *v:swapname* *swapname-variable*
1468v:swapname Only valid when executing |SwapExists| autocommands: Name of
1469 the swap file found. Read-only.
1470
1471 *v:swapchoice* *swapchoice-variable*
1472v:swapchoice |SwapExists| autocommands can set this to the selected choice
1473 for handling an existing swap file:
1474 'o' Open read-only
1475 'e' Edit anyway
1476 'r' Recover
1477 'd' Delete swapfile
1478 'q' Quit
1479 'a' Abort
1480 The value should be a single-character string. An empty value
1481 results in the user being asked, as would happen when there is
1482 no SwapExists autocommand. The default is empty.
1483
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00001484 *v:swapcommand* *swapcommand-variable*
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00001485v:swapcommand Normal mode command to be executed after a file has been
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00001486 opened. Can be used for a |SwapExists| autocommand to have
1487 another Vim open the file and jump to the right place. For
1488 example, when jumping to a tag the value is ":tag tagname\r".
Bram Moolenaar1f35bf92006-03-07 22:38:47 +00001489 For ":edit +cmd file" the value is ":cmd\r".
Bram Moolenaarb3480382005-12-11 21:33:32 +00001490
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001491 *v:termresponse* *termresponse-variable*
1492v:termresponse The escape sequence returned by the terminal for the |t_RV|
1493 termcap entry. It is set when Vim receives an escape sequence
1494 that starts with ESC [ or CSI and ends in a 'c', with only
1495 digits, ';' and '.' in between.
1496 When this option is set, the TermResponse autocommand event is
1497 fired, so that you can react to the response from the
1498 terminal.
1499 The response from a new xterm is: "<Esc>[ Pp ; Pv ; Pc c". Pp
1500 is the terminal type: 0 for vt100 and 1 for vt220. Pv is the
1501 patch level (since this was introduced in patch 95, it's
1502 always 95 or bigger). Pc is always zero.
1503 {only when compiled with |+termresponse| feature}
1504
1505 *v:this_session* *this_session-variable*
1506v:this_session Full filename of the last loaded or saved session file. See
1507 |:mksession|. It is allowed to set this variable. When no
1508 session file has been saved, this variable is empty.
1509 "this_session" also works, for backwards compatibility.
1510
1511 *v:throwpoint* *throwpoint-variable*
1512v:throwpoint The point where the exception most recently caught and not
1513 finished was thrown. Not set when commands are typed. See
1514 also |v:exception| and |throw-variables|.
1515 Example: >
1516 :try
1517 : throw "oops"
1518 :catch /.*/
1519 : echo "Exception from" v:throwpoint
1520 :endtry
1521< Output: "Exception from test.vim, line 2"
1522
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00001523 *v:val* *val-variable*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00001524v:val Value of the current item of a |List| or |Dictionary|. Only
1525 valid while evaluating the expression used with |map()| and
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00001526 |filter()|. Read-only.
1527
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001528 *v:version* *version-variable*
1529v:version Version number of Vim: Major version number times 100 plus
1530 minor version number. Version 5.0 is 500. Version 5.1 (5.01)
1531 is 501. Read-only. "version" also works, for backwards
1532 compatibility.
1533 Use |has()| to check if a certain patch was included, e.g.: >
1534 if has("patch123")
1535< Note that patch numbers are specific to the version, thus both
1536 version 5.0 and 5.1 may have a patch 123, but these are
1537 completely different.
1538
1539 *v:warningmsg* *warningmsg-variable*
1540v:warningmsg Last given warning message. It's allowed to set this variable.
1541
1542==============================================================================
15434. Builtin Functions *functions*
1544
1545See |function-list| for a list grouped by what the function is used for.
1546
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00001547(Use CTRL-] on the function name to jump to the full explanation.)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001548
1549USAGE RESULT DESCRIPTION ~
1550
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00001551add( {list}, {item}) List append {item} to |List| {list}
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001552append( {lnum}, {string}) Number append {string} below line {lnum}
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00001553append( {lnum}, {list}) Number append lines {list} below line {lnum}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001554argc() Number number of files in the argument list
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001555argidx() Number current index in the argument list
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001556argv( {nr}) String {nr} entry of the argument list
Bram Moolenaare2f98b92006-03-29 21:18:24 +00001557argv( ) List the argument list
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001558browse( {save}, {title}, {initdir}, {default})
1559 String put up a file requester
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001560browsedir( {title}, {initdir}) String put up a directory requester
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001561bufexists( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} exists
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001562buflisted( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} is listed
1563bufloaded( {expr}) Number TRUE if buffer {expr} is loaded
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001564bufname( {expr}) String Name of the buffer {expr}
1565bufnr( {expr}) Number Number of the buffer {expr}
1566bufwinnr( {expr}) Number window number of buffer {expr}
1567byte2line( {byte}) Number line number at byte count {byte}
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001568byteidx( {expr}, {nr}) Number byte index of {nr}'th char in {expr}
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00001569call( {func}, {arglist} [, {dict}])
1570 any call {func} with arguments {arglist}
Bram Moolenaarca003e12006-03-17 23:19:38 +00001571changenr() Number current change number
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001572char2nr( {expr}) Number ASCII value of first char in {expr}
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001573cindent( {lnum}) Number C indent for line {lnum}
Bram Moolenaar6ee10162007-07-26 20:58:42 +00001574clearmatches() None clear all matches
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001575col( {expr}) Number column nr of cursor or mark
Bram Moolenaara94bc432006-03-10 21:42:59 +00001576complete({startcol}, {matches}) String set Insert mode completion
Bram Moolenaar572cb562005-08-05 21:35:02 +00001577complete_add( {expr}) Number add completion match
1578complete_check() Number check for key typed during completion
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001579confirm( {msg} [, {choices} [, {default} [, {type}]]])
1580 Number number of choice picked by user
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001581copy( {expr}) any make a shallow copy of {expr}
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00001582count( {list}, {expr} [, {start} [, {ic}]])
1583 Number count how many {expr} are in {list}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001584cscope_connection( [{num} , {dbpath} [, {prepend}]])
1585 Number checks existence of cscope connection
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00001586cursor( {lnum}, {col} [, {coladd}])
1587 Number move cursor to {lnum}, {col}, {coladd}
1588cursor( {list}) Number move cursor to position in {list}
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001589deepcopy( {expr}) any make a full copy of {expr}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001590delete( {fname}) Number delete file {fname}
1591did_filetype() Number TRUE if FileType autocommand event used
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001592diff_filler( {lnum}) Number diff filler lines about {lnum}
1593diff_hlID( {lnum}, {col}) Number diff highlighting at {lnum}/{col}
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +00001594empty( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} is empty
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001595escape( {string}, {chars}) String escape {chars} in {string} with '\'
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00001596eval( {string}) any evaluate {string} into its value
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001597eventhandler( ) Number TRUE if inside an event handler
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001598executable( {expr}) Number 1 if executable {expr} exists
1599exists( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} exists
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001600extend({expr1}, {expr2} [, {expr3}])
1601 List/Dict insert items of {expr2} into {expr1}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001602expand( {expr}) String expand special keywords in {expr}
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00001603feedkeys( {string} [, {mode}]) Number add key sequence to typeahead buffer
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001604filereadable( {file}) Number TRUE if {file} is a readable file
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001605filewritable( {file}) Number TRUE if {file} is a writable file
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00001606filter( {expr}, {string}) List/Dict remove items from {expr} where
1607 {string} is 0
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00001608finddir( {name}[, {path}[, {count}]])
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001609 String find directory {name} in {path}
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00001610findfile( {name}[, {path}[, {count}]])
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001611 String find file {name} in {path}
Bram Moolenaaraebaf892008-05-28 14:49:58 +00001612fnameescape( {fname}) String escape special characters in {fname}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001613fnamemodify( {fname}, {mods}) String modify file name
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001614foldclosed( {lnum}) Number first line of fold at {lnum} if closed
1615foldclosedend( {lnum}) Number last line of fold at {lnum} if closed
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001616foldlevel( {lnum}) Number fold level at {lnum}
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001617foldtext( ) String line displayed for closed fold
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001618foldtextresult( {lnum}) String text for closed fold at {lnum}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001619foreground( ) Number bring the Vim window to the foreground
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001620function( {name}) Funcref reference to function {name}
Bram Moolenaar9d2c8c12007-09-25 16:00:00 +00001621garbagecollect( [at_exit]) none free memory, breaking cyclic references
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001622get( {list}, {idx} [, {def}]) any get item {idx} from {list} or {def}
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00001623get( {dict}, {key} [, {def}]) any get item {key} from {dict} or {def}
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00001624getbufline( {expr}, {lnum} [, {end}])
1625 List lines {lnum} to {end} of buffer {expr}
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001626getbufvar( {expr}, {varname}) any variable {varname} in buffer {expr}
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001627getchar( [expr]) Number get one character from the user
1628getcharmod( ) Number modifiers for the last typed character
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001629getcmdline() String return the current command-line
1630getcmdpos() Number return cursor position in command-line
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00001631getcmdtype() String return the current command-line type
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001632getcwd() String the current working directory
Bram Moolenaar5eb86f92004-07-26 12:53:41 +00001633getfperm( {fname}) String file permissions of file {fname}
1634getfsize( {fname}) Number size in bytes of file {fname}
Bram Moolenaard8b0cf12004-12-12 11:33:30 +00001635getfontname( [{name}]) String name of font being used
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001636getftime( {fname}) Number last modification time of file
Bram Moolenaar5eb86f92004-07-26 12:53:41 +00001637getftype( {fname}) String description of type of file {fname}
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00001638getline( {lnum}) String line {lnum} of current buffer
1639getline( {lnum}, {end}) List lines {lnum} to {end} of current buffer
Bram Moolenaar17c7c012006-01-26 22:25:15 +00001640getloclist({nr}) List list of location list items
Bram Moolenaar6ee10162007-07-26 20:58:42 +00001641getmatches() List list of current matches
Bram Moolenaar18081e32008-02-20 19:11:07 +00001642getpid() Number process ID of Vim
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00001643getpos( {expr}) List position of cursor, mark, etc.
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00001644getqflist() List list of quickfix items
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00001645getreg( [{regname} [, 1]]) String contents of register
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001646getregtype( [{regname}]) String type of register
Bram Moolenaarc6249bb2006-04-15 20:25:09 +00001647gettabwinvar( {tabnr}, {winnr}, {name})
1648 any {name} in {winnr} in tab page {tabnr}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001649getwinposx() Number X coord in pixels of GUI Vim window
1650getwinposy() Number Y coord in pixels of GUI Vim window
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001651getwinvar( {nr}, {varname}) any variable {varname} in window {nr}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001652glob( {expr}) String expand file wildcards in {expr}
1653globpath( {path}, {expr}) String do glob({expr}) for all dirs in {path}
1654has( {feature}) Number TRUE if feature {feature} supported
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00001655has_key( {dict}, {key}) Number TRUE if {dict} has entry {key}
Bram Moolenaard267b9c2007-04-26 15:06:45 +00001656haslocaldir() Number TRUE if current window executed |:lcd|
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00001657hasmapto( {what} [, {mode} [, {abbr}]])
1658 Number TRUE if mapping to {what} exists
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001659histadd( {history},{item}) String add an item to a history
1660histdel( {history} [, {item}]) String remove an item from a history
1661histget( {history} [, {index}]) String get the item {index} from a history
1662histnr( {history}) Number highest index of a history
1663hlexists( {name}) Number TRUE if highlight group {name} exists
1664hlID( {name}) Number syntax ID of highlight group {name}
1665hostname() String name of the machine Vim is running on
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001666iconv( {expr}, {from}, {to}) String convert encoding of {expr}
1667indent( {lnum}) Number indent of line {lnum}
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00001668index( {list}, {expr} [, {start} [, {ic}]])
1669 Number index in {list} where {expr} appears
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00001670input( {prompt} [, {text} [, {completion}]])
1671 String get input from the user
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001672inputdialog( {p} [, {t} [, {c}]]) String like input() but in a GUI dialog
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001673inputlist( {textlist}) Number let the user pick from a choice list
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001674inputrestore() Number restore typeahead
1675inputsave() Number save and clear typeahead
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001676inputsecret( {prompt} [, {text}]) String like input() but hiding the text
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001677insert( {list}, {item} [, {idx}]) List insert {item} in {list} [before {idx}]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001678isdirectory( {directory}) Number TRUE if {directory} is a directory
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00001679islocked( {expr}) Number TRUE if {expr} is locked
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00001680items( {dict}) List key-value pairs in {dict}
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00001681join( {list} [, {sep}]) String join {list} items into one String
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00001682keys( {dict}) List keys in {dict}
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001683len( {expr}) Number the length of {expr}
1684libcall( {lib}, {func}, {arg}) String call {func} in library {lib} with {arg}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001685libcallnr( {lib}, {func}, {arg}) Number idem, but return a Number
1686line( {expr}) Number line nr of cursor, last line or mark
1687line2byte( {lnum}) Number byte count of line {lnum}
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001688lispindent( {lnum}) Number Lisp indent for line {lnum}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001689localtime() Number current time
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00001690map( {expr}, {string}) List/Dict change each item in {expr} to {expr}
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00001691maparg( {name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]])
1692 String rhs of mapping {name} in mode {mode}
1693mapcheck( {name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]])
1694 String check for mappings matching {name}
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00001695match( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001696 Number position where {pat} matches in {expr}
Bram Moolenaar6ee10162007-07-26 20:58:42 +00001697matchadd( {group}, {pattern}[, {priority}[, {id}]])
1698 Number highlight {pattern} with {group}
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001699matcharg( {nr}) List arguments of |:match|
Bram Moolenaar6ee10162007-07-26 20:58:42 +00001700matchdelete( {id}) Number delete match identified by {id}
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00001701matchend( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001702 Number position where {pat} ends in {expr}
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00001703matchlist( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
1704 List match and submatches of {pat} in {expr}
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00001705matchstr( {expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]])
1706 String {count}'th match of {pat} in {expr}
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00001707max({list}) Number maximum value of items in {list}
Bram Moolenaar79166c42007-05-10 18:29:51 +00001708min({list}) Number minimum value of items in {list}
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00001709mkdir({name} [, {path} [, {prot}]])
1710 Number create directory {name}
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001711mode() String current editing mode
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001712nextnonblank( {lnum}) Number line nr of non-blank line >= {lnum}
1713nr2char( {expr}) String single char with ASCII value {expr}
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00001714pathshorten( {expr}) String shorten directory names in a path
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001715prevnonblank( {lnum}) Number line nr of non-blank line <= {lnum}
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00001716printf( {fmt}, {expr1}...) String format text
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00001717pumvisible() Number whether popup menu is visible
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00001718range( {expr} [, {max} [, {stride}]])
1719 List items from {expr} to {max}
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00001720readfile({fname} [, {binary} [, {max}]])
1721 List get list of lines from file {fname}
Bram Moolenaar433f7c82006-03-21 21:29:36 +00001722reltime( [{start} [, {end}]]) List get time value
1723reltimestr( {time}) String turn time value into a String
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001724remote_expr( {server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
1725 String send expression
1726remote_foreground( {server}) Number bring Vim server to the foreground
1727remote_peek( {serverid} [, {retvar}])
1728 Number check for reply string
1729remote_read( {serverid}) String read reply string
1730remote_send( {server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
1731 String send key sequence
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00001732remove( {list}, {idx} [, {end}]) any remove items {idx}-{end} from {list}
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00001733remove( {dict}, {key}) any remove entry {key} from {dict}
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001734rename( {from}, {to}) Number rename (move) file from {from} to {to}
1735repeat( {expr}, {count}) String repeat {expr} {count} times
1736resolve( {filename}) String get filename a shortcut points to
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001737reverse( {list}) List reverse {list} in-place
Bram Moolenaar76929292008-01-06 19:07:36 +00001738search( {pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]])
1739 Number search for {pattern}
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +00001740searchdecl({name} [, {global} [, {thisblock}]])
1741 Number search for variable declaration
Bram Moolenaar76929292008-01-06 19:07:36 +00001742searchpair( {start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [...]]])
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001743 Number search for other end of start/end pair
Bram Moolenaar76929292008-01-06 19:07:36 +00001744searchpairpos( {start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip} [...]]])
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00001745 List search for other end of start/end pair
Bram Moolenaar76929292008-01-06 19:07:36 +00001746searchpos( {pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]])
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00001747 List search for {pattern}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001748server2client( {clientid}, {string})
1749 Number send reply string
1750serverlist() String get a list of available servers
1751setbufvar( {expr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in buffer {expr} to {val}
1752setcmdpos( {pos}) Number set cursor position in command-line
1753setline( {lnum}, {line}) Number set line {lnum} to {line}
Bram Moolenaar17c7c012006-01-26 22:25:15 +00001754setloclist( {nr}, {list}[, {action}])
1755 Number modify location list using {list}
Bram Moolenaar6ee10162007-07-26 20:58:42 +00001756setmatches( {list}) Number restore a list of matches
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00001757setpos( {expr}, {list}) none set the {expr} position to {list}
Bram Moolenaar17c7c012006-01-26 22:25:15 +00001758setqflist( {list}[, {action}]) Number modify quickfix list using {list}
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001759setreg( {n}, {v}[, {opt}]) Number set register to value and type
Bram Moolenaarc6249bb2006-04-15 20:25:09 +00001760settabwinvar( {tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in window
1761 {winnr} in tab page {tabnr} to {val}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001762setwinvar( {nr}, {varname}, {val}) set {varname} in window {nr} to {val}
Bram Moolenaar60a495f2006-10-03 12:44:42 +00001763shellescape( {string}) String escape {string} for use as shell
1764 command argument
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001765simplify( {filename}) String simplify filename as much as possible
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001766sort( {list} [, {func}]) List sort {list}, using {func} to compare
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00001767soundfold( {word}) String sound-fold {word}
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00001768spellbadword() String badly spelled word at cursor
Bram Moolenaarc54b8a72005-09-30 21:20:29 +00001769spellsuggest( {word} [, {max} [, {capital}]])
1770 List spelling suggestions
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00001771split( {expr} [, {pat} [, {keepempty}]])
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00001772 List make |List| from {pat} separated {expr}
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00001773str2nr( {expr} [, {base}]) Number convert string to number
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001774strftime( {format}[, {time}]) String time in specified format
Bram Moolenaar8f999f12005-01-25 22:12:55 +00001775stridx( {haystack}, {needle}[, {start}])
1776 Number index of {needle} in {haystack}
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00001777string( {expr}) String String representation of {expr} value
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001778strlen( {expr}) Number length of the String {expr}
1779strpart( {src}, {start}[, {len}])
1780 String {len} characters of {src} at {start}
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00001781strridx( {haystack}, {needle} [, {start}])
1782 Number last index of {needle} in {haystack}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001783strtrans( {expr}) String translate string to make it printable
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001784submatch( {nr}) String specific match in ":substitute"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001785substitute( {expr}, {pat}, {sub}, {flags})
1786 String all {pat} in {expr} replaced with {sub}
Bram Moolenaar47136d72004-10-12 20:02:24 +00001787synID( {lnum}, {col}, {trans}) Number syntax ID at {lnum} and {col}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001788synIDattr( {synID}, {what} [, {mode}])
1789 String attribute {what} of syntax ID {synID}
1790synIDtrans( {synID}) Number translated syntax ID of {synID}
Bram Moolenaar9d188ab2008-01-10 21:24:39 +00001791synstack({lnum}, {col}) List stack of syntax IDs at {lnum} and {col}
Bram Moolenaarc0197e22004-09-13 20:26:32 +00001792system( {expr} [, {input}]) String output of shell command/filter {expr}
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00001793tabpagebuflist( [{arg}]) List list of buffer numbers in tab page
1794tabpagenr( [{arg}]) Number number of current or last tab page
1795tabpagewinnr( {tabarg}[, {arg}])
1796 Number number of current window in tab page
1797taglist( {expr}) List list of tags matching {expr}
Bram Moolenaare7eb9df2005-09-09 19:49:30 +00001798tagfiles() List tags files used
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001799tempname() String name for a temporary file
1800tolower( {expr}) String the String {expr} switched to lowercase
1801toupper( {expr}) String the String {expr} switched to uppercase
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00001802tr( {src}, {fromstr}, {tostr}) String translate chars of {src} in {fromstr}
1803 to chars in {tostr}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001804type( {name}) Number type of variable {name}
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00001805values( {dict}) List values in {dict}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001806virtcol( {expr}) Number screen column of cursor or mark
1807visualmode( [expr]) String last visual mode used
1808winbufnr( {nr}) Number buffer number of window {nr}
1809wincol() Number window column of the cursor
1810winheight( {nr}) Number height of window {nr}
1811winline() Number window line of the cursor
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00001812winnr( [{expr}]) Number number of current window
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001813winrestcmd() String returns command to restore window sizes
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00001814winrestview({dict}) None restore view of current window
1815winsaveview() Dict save view of current window
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001816winwidth( {nr}) Number width of window {nr}
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00001817writefile({list}, {fname} [, {binary}])
1818 Number write list of lines to file {fname}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001819
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001820add({list}, {expr}) *add()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00001821 Append the item {expr} to |List| {list}. Returns the
1822 resulting |List|. Examples: >
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001823 :let alist = add([1, 2, 3], item)
1824 :call add(mylist, "woodstock")
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00001825< Note that when {expr} is a |List| it is appended as a single
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00001826 item. Use |extend()| to concatenate |Lists|.
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +00001827 Use |insert()| to add an item at another position.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001828
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001829
1830append({lnum}, {expr}) *append()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00001831 When {expr} is a |List|: Append each item of the |List| as a
1832 text line below line {lnum} in the current buffer.
Bram Moolenaar748bf032005-02-02 23:04:36 +00001833 Otherwise append {expr} as one text line below line {lnum} in
1834 the current buffer.
1835 {lnum} can be zero to insert a line before the first one.
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001836 Returns 1 for failure ({lnum} out of range or out of memory),
1837 0 for success. Example: >
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001838 :let failed = append(line('$'), "# THE END")
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00001839 :let failed = append(0, ["Chapter 1", "the beginning"])
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00001840<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001841 *argc()*
1842argc() The result is the number of files in the argument list of the
1843 current window. See |arglist|.
1844
1845 *argidx()*
1846argidx() The result is the current index in the argument list. 0 is
1847 the first file. argc() - 1 is the last one. See |arglist|.
1848
1849 *argv()*
Bram Moolenaare2f98b92006-03-29 21:18:24 +00001850argv([{nr}]) The result is the {nr}th file in the argument list of the
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001851 current window. See |arglist|. "argv(0)" is the first one.
1852 Example: >
1853 :let i = 0
1854 :while i < argc()
1855 : let f = escape(argv(i), '. ')
1856 : exe 'amenu Arg.' . f . ' :e ' . f . '<CR>'
1857 : let i = i + 1
1858 :endwhile
Bram Moolenaare2f98b92006-03-29 21:18:24 +00001859< Without the {nr} argument a |List| with the whole |arglist| is
1860 returned.
1861
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001862 *browse()*
1863browse({save}, {title}, {initdir}, {default})
1864 Put up a file requester. This only works when "has("browse")"
1865 returns non-zero (only in some GUI versions).
1866 The input fields are:
1867 {save} when non-zero, select file to write
1868 {title} title for the requester
1869 {initdir} directory to start browsing in
1870 {default} default file name
1871 When the "Cancel" button is hit, something went wrong, or
1872 browsing is not possible, an empty string is returned.
1873
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00001874 *browsedir()*
1875browsedir({title}, {initdir})
1876 Put up a directory requester. This only works when
1877 "has("browse")" returns non-zero (only in some GUI versions).
1878 On systems where a directory browser is not supported a file
1879 browser is used. In that case: select a file in the directory
1880 to be used.
1881 The input fields are:
1882 {title} title for the requester
1883 {initdir} directory to start browsing in
1884 When the "Cancel" button is hit, something went wrong, or
1885 browsing is not possible, an empty string is returned.
1886
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001887bufexists({expr}) *bufexists()*
1888 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called
1889 {expr} exists.
Bram Moolenaar69a7cb42004-06-20 12:51:53 +00001890 If the {expr} argument is a number, buffer numbers are used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001891 If the {expr} argument is a string it must match a buffer name
Bram Moolenaar69a7cb42004-06-20 12:51:53 +00001892 exactly. The name can be:
1893 - Relative to the current directory.
1894 - A full path.
1895 - The name of a buffer with 'filetype' set to "nofile".
1896 - A URL name.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001897 Unlisted buffers will be found.
1898 Note that help files are listed by their short name in the
1899 output of |:buffers|, but bufexists() requires using their
1900 long name to be able to find them.
1901 Use "bufexists(0)" to test for the existence of an alternate
1902 file name.
1903 *buffer_exists()*
1904 Obsolete name: buffer_exists().
1905
1906buflisted({expr}) *buflisted()*
1907 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called
1908 {expr} exists and is listed (has the 'buflisted' option set).
Bram Moolenaar69a7cb42004-06-20 12:51:53 +00001909 The {expr} argument is used like with |bufexists()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001910
1911bufloaded({expr}) *bufloaded()*
1912 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a buffer called
1913 {expr} exists and is loaded (shown in a window or hidden).
Bram Moolenaar69a7cb42004-06-20 12:51:53 +00001914 The {expr} argument is used like with |bufexists()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001915
1916bufname({expr}) *bufname()*
1917 The result is the name of a buffer, as it is displayed by the
1918 ":ls" command.
1919 If {expr} is a Number, that buffer number's name is given.
1920 Number zero is the alternate buffer for the current window.
1921 If {expr} is a String, it is used as a |file-pattern| to match
1922 with the buffer names. This is always done like 'magic' is
1923 set and 'cpoptions' is empty. When there is more than one
1924 match an empty string is returned.
1925 "" or "%" can be used for the current buffer, "#" for the
1926 alternate buffer.
1927 A full match is preferred, otherwise a match at the start, end
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00001928 or middle of the buffer name is accepted. If you only want a
1929 full match then put "^" at the start and "$" at the end of the
1930 pattern.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001931 Listed buffers are found first. If there is a single match
1932 with a listed buffer, that one is returned. Next unlisted
1933 buffers are searched for.
1934 If the {expr} is a String, but you want to use it as a buffer
1935 number, force it to be a Number by adding zero to it: >
1936 :echo bufname("3" + 0)
1937< If the buffer doesn't exist, or doesn't have a name, an empty
1938 string is returned. >
1939 bufname("#") alternate buffer name
1940 bufname(3) name of buffer 3
1941 bufname("%") name of current buffer
1942 bufname("file2") name of buffer where "file2" matches.
1943< *buffer_name()*
1944 Obsolete name: buffer_name().
1945
1946 *bufnr()*
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00001947bufnr({expr} [, {create}])
1948 The result is the number of a buffer, as it is displayed by
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001949 the ":ls" command. For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()|
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00001950 above.
1951 If the buffer doesn't exist, -1 is returned. Or, if the
1952 {create} argument is present and not zero, a new, unlisted,
1953 buffer is created and its number is returned.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001954 bufnr("$") is the last buffer: >
1955 :let last_buffer = bufnr("$")
1956< The result is a Number, which is the highest buffer number
1957 of existing buffers. Note that not all buffers with a smaller
1958 number necessarily exist, because ":bwipeout" may have removed
1959 them. Use bufexists() to test for the existence of a buffer.
1960 *buffer_number()*
1961 Obsolete name: buffer_number().
1962 *last_buffer_nr()*
1963 Obsolete name for bufnr("$"): last_buffer_nr().
1964
1965bufwinnr({expr}) *bufwinnr()*
1966 The result is a Number, which is the number of the first
1967 window associated with buffer {expr}. For the use of {expr},
1968 see |bufname()| above. If buffer {expr} doesn't exist or
1969 there is no such window, -1 is returned. Example: >
1970
1971 echo "A window containing buffer 1 is " . (bufwinnr(1))
1972
1973< The number can be used with |CTRL-W_w| and ":wincmd w"
1974 |:wincmd|.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00001975 Only deals with the current tab page.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00001976
1977
1978byte2line({byte}) *byte2line()*
1979 Return the line number that contains the character at byte
1980 count {byte} in the current buffer. This includes the
1981 end-of-line character, depending on the 'fileformat' option
1982 for the current buffer. The first character has byte count
1983 one.
1984 Also see |line2byte()|, |go| and |:goto|.
1985 {not available when compiled without the |+byte_offset|
1986 feature}
1987
Bram Moolenaarab79bcb2004-07-18 21:34:53 +00001988byteidx({expr}, {nr}) *byteidx()*
1989 Return byte index of the {nr}'th character in the string
1990 {expr}. Use zero for the first character, it returns zero.
1991 This function is only useful when there are multibyte
1992 characters, otherwise the returned value is equal to {nr}.
1993 Composing characters are counted as a separate character.
1994 Example : >
1995 echo matchstr(str, ".", byteidx(str, 3))
1996< will display the fourth character. Another way to do the
1997 same: >
1998 let s = strpart(str, byteidx(str, 3))
1999 echo strpart(s, 0, byteidx(s, 1))
2000< If there are less than {nr} characters -1 is returned.
2001 If there are exactly {nr} characters the length of the string
2002 is returned.
2003
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002004call({func}, {arglist} [, {dict}]) *call()* *E699*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002005 Call function {func} with the items in |List| {arglist} as
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00002006 arguments.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002007 {func} can either be a |Funcref| or the name of a function.
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00002008 a:firstline and a:lastline are set to the cursor line.
2009 Returns the return value of the called function.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002010 {dict} is for functions with the "dict" attribute. It will be
2011 used to set the local variable "self". |Dictionary-function|
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00002012
Bram Moolenaarca003e12006-03-17 23:19:38 +00002013changenr() *changenr()*
2014 Return the number of the most recent change. This is the same
2015 number as what is displayed with |:undolist| and can be used
2016 with the |:undo| command.
2017 When a change was made it is the number of that change. After
2018 redo it is the number of the redone change. After undo it is
2019 one less than the number of the undone change.
2020
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002021char2nr({expr}) *char2nr()*
2022 Return number value of the first char in {expr}. Examples: >
2023 char2nr(" ") returns 32
2024 char2nr("ABC") returns 65
2025< The current 'encoding' is used. Example for "utf-8": >
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00002026 char2nr("á") returns 225
2027 char2nr("á"[0]) returns 195
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00002028< nr2char() does the opposite.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002029
2030cindent({lnum}) *cindent()*
2031 Get the amount of indent for line {lnum} according the C
2032 indenting rules, as with 'cindent'.
2033 The indent is counted in spaces, the value of 'tabstop' is
2034 relevant. {lnum} is used just like in |getline()|.
2035 When {lnum} is invalid or Vim was not compiled the |+cindent|
2036 feature, -1 is returned.
Bram Moolenaard5cdbeb2005-10-10 20:59:28 +00002037 See |C-indenting|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002038
Bram Moolenaar6ee10162007-07-26 20:58:42 +00002039clearmatches() *clearmatches()*
2040 Clears all matches previously defined by |matchadd()| and the
2041 |:match| commands.
2042
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002043 *col()*
Bram Moolenaarc0197e22004-09-13 20:26:32 +00002044col({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the byte index of the column
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002045 position given with {expr}. The accepted positions are:
2046 . the cursor position
2047 $ the end of the cursor line (the result is the
2048 number of characters in the cursor line plus one)
2049 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is
2050 returned)
Bram Moolenaar477933c2007-07-17 14:32:23 +00002051 Additionally {expr} can be [lnum, col]: a |List| with the line
2052 and column number. Most useful when the column is "$", to get
2053 the las column of a specific line. When "lnum" or "col" is
2054 out of range then col() returns zero.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00002055 To get the line number use |line()|. To get both use
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00002056 |getpos()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002057 For the screen column position use |virtcol()|.
2058 Note that only marks in the current file can be used.
2059 Examples: >
2060 col(".") column of cursor
2061 col("$") length of cursor line plus one
2062 col("'t") column of mark t
2063 col("'" . markname) column of mark markname
2064< The first column is 1. 0 is returned for an error.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00002065 For an uppercase mark the column may actually be in another
2066 buffer.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002067 For the cursor position, when 'virtualedit' is active, the
2068 column is one higher if the cursor is after the end of the
2069 line. This can be used to obtain the column in Insert mode: >
2070 :imap <F2> <C-O>:let save_ve = &ve<CR>
2071 \<C-O>:set ve=all<CR>
2072 \<C-O>:echo col(".") . "\n" <Bar>
2073 \let &ve = save_ve<CR>
2074<
Bram Moolenaar572cb562005-08-05 21:35:02 +00002075
Bram Moolenaara94bc432006-03-10 21:42:59 +00002076complete({startcol}, {matches}) *complete()* *E785*
2077 Set the matches for Insert mode completion.
2078 Can only be used in Insert mode. You need to use a mapping
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00002079 with CTRL-R = |i_CTRL-R|. It does not work after CTRL-O or
2080 with an expression mapping.
Bram Moolenaara94bc432006-03-10 21:42:59 +00002081 {startcol} is the byte offset in the line where the completed
2082 text start. The text up to the cursor is the original text
2083 that will be replaced by the matches. Use col('.') for an
2084 empty string. "col('.') - 1" will replace one character by a
2085 match.
2086 {matches} must be a |List|. Each |List| item is one match.
2087 See |complete-items| for the kind of items that are possible.
2088 Note that the after calling this function you need to avoid
2089 inserting anything that would completion to stop.
2090 The match can be selected with CTRL-N and CTRL-P as usual with
2091 Insert mode completion. The popup menu will appear if
2092 specified, see |ins-completion-menu|.
2093 Example: >
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00002094 inoremap <F5> <C-R>=ListMonths()<CR>
Bram Moolenaara94bc432006-03-10 21:42:59 +00002095
2096 func! ListMonths()
2097 call complete(col('.'), ['January', 'February', 'March',
2098 \ 'April', 'May', 'June', 'July', 'August', 'September',
2099 \ 'October', 'November', 'December'])
2100 return ''
2101 endfunc
2102< This isn't very useful, but it shows how it works. Note that
2103 an empty string is returned to avoid a zero being inserted.
2104
Bram Moolenaar572cb562005-08-05 21:35:02 +00002105complete_add({expr}) *complete_add()*
2106 Add {expr} to the list of matches. Only to be used by the
2107 function specified with the 'completefunc' option.
2108 Returns 0 for failure (empty string or out of memory),
2109 1 when the match was added, 2 when the match was already in
2110 the list.
Bram Moolenaar39f05632006-03-19 22:15:26 +00002111 See |complete-functions| for an explanation of {expr}. It is
2112 the same as one item in the list that 'omnifunc' would return.
Bram Moolenaar572cb562005-08-05 21:35:02 +00002113
2114complete_check() *complete_check()*
2115 Check for a key typed while looking for completion matches.
2116 This is to be used when looking for matches takes some time.
2117 Returns non-zero when searching for matches is to be aborted,
2118 zero otherwise.
2119 Only to be used by the function specified with the
2120 'completefunc' option.
2121
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002122 *confirm()*
2123confirm({msg} [, {choices} [, {default} [, {type}]]])
2124 Confirm() offers the user a dialog, from which a choice can be
2125 made. It returns the number of the choice. For the first
2126 choice this is 1.
2127 Note: confirm() is only supported when compiled with dialog
2128 support, see |+dialog_con| and |+dialog_gui|.
2129 {msg} is displayed in a |dialog| with {choices} as the
2130 alternatives. When {choices} is missing or empty, "&OK" is
2131 used (and translated).
2132 {msg} is a String, use '\n' to include a newline. Only on
2133 some systems the string is wrapped when it doesn't fit.
2134 {choices} is a String, with the individual choices separated
2135 by '\n', e.g. >
2136 confirm("Save changes?", "&Yes\n&No\n&Cancel")
2137< The letter after the '&' is the shortcut key for that choice.
2138 Thus you can type 'c' to select "Cancel". The shortcut does
2139 not need to be the first letter: >
2140 confirm("file has been modified", "&Save\nSave &All")
2141< For the console, the first letter of each choice is used as
2142 the default shortcut key.
2143 The optional {default} argument is the number of the choice
2144 that is made if the user hits <CR>. Use 1 to make the first
2145 choice the default one. Use 0 to not set a default. If
2146 {default} is omitted, 1 is used.
2147 The optional {type} argument gives the type of dialog. This
2148 is only used for the icon of the Win32 GUI. It can be one of
2149 these values: "Error", "Question", "Info", "Warning" or
2150 "Generic". Only the first character is relevant. When {type}
2151 is omitted, "Generic" is used.
2152 If the user aborts the dialog by pressing <Esc>, CTRL-C,
2153 or another valid interrupt key, confirm() returns 0.
2154
2155 An example: >
2156 :let choice = confirm("What do you want?", "&Apples\n&Oranges\n&Bananas", 2)
2157 :if choice == 0
2158 : echo "make up your mind!"
2159 :elseif choice == 3
2160 : echo "tasteful"
2161 :else
2162 : echo "I prefer bananas myself."
2163 :endif
2164< In a GUI dialog, buttons are used. The layout of the buttons
2165 depends on the 'v' flag in 'guioptions'. If it is included,
2166 the buttons are always put vertically. Otherwise, confirm()
2167 tries to put the buttons in one horizontal line. If they
2168 don't fit, a vertical layout is used anyway. For some systems
2169 the horizontal layout is always used.
2170
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00002171 *copy()*
2172copy({expr}) Make a copy of {expr}. For Numbers and Strings this isn't
2173 different from using {expr} directly.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002174 When {expr} is a |List| a shallow copy is created. This means
2175 that the original |List| can be changed without changing the
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00002176 copy, and vise versa. But the items are identical, thus
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00002177 changing an item changes the contents of both |Lists|. Also
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002178 see |deepcopy()|.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00002179
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002180count({comp}, {expr} [, {ic} [, {start}]]) *count()*
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00002181 Return the number of times an item with value {expr} appears
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002182 in |List| or |Dictionary| {comp}.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002183 If {start} is given then start with the item with this index.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002184 {start} can only be used with a |List|.
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00002185 When {ic} is given and it's non-zero then case is ignored.
2186
2187
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002188 *cscope_connection()*
2189cscope_connection([{num} , {dbpath} [, {prepend}]])
2190 Checks for the existence of a |cscope| connection. If no
2191 parameters are specified, then the function returns:
2192 0, if cscope was not available (not compiled in), or
2193 if there are no cscope connections;
2194 1, if there is at least one cscope connection.
2195
2196 If parameters are specified, then the value of {num}
2197 determines how existence of a cscope connection is checked:
2198
2199 {num} Description of existence check
2200 ----- ------------------------------
2201 0 Same as no parameters (e.g., "cscope_connection()").
2202 1 Ignore {prepend}, and use partial string matches for
2203 {dbpath}.
2204 2 Ignore {prepend}, and use exact string matches for
2205 {dbpath}.
2206 3 Use {prepend}, use partial string matches for both
2207 {dbpath} and {prepend}.
2208 4 Use {prepend}, use exact string matches for both
2209 {dbpath} and {prepend}.
2210
2211 Note: All string comparisons are case sensitive!
2212
2213 Examples. Suppose we had the following (from ":cs show"): >
2214
2215 # pid database name prepend path
2216 0 27664 cscope.out /usr/local
2217<
2218 Invocation Return Val ~
2219 ---------- ---------- >
2220 cscope_connection() 1
2221 cscope_connection(1, "out") 1
2222 cscope_connection(2, "out") 0
2223 cscope_connection(3, "out") 0
2224 cscope_connection(3, "out", "local") 1
2225 cscope_connection(4, "out") 0
2226 cscope_connection(4, "out", "local") 0
2227 cscope_connection(4, "cscope.out", "/usr/local") 1
2228<
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00002229cursor({lnum}, {col} [, {off}]) *cursor()*
2230cursor({list})
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00002231 Positions the cursor at the column (byte count) {col} in the
2232 line {lnum}. The first column is one.
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00002233 When there is one argument {list} this is used as a |List|
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00002234 with two or three items {lnum}, {col} and {off}. This is like
2235 the return value of |getpos()|, but without the first item.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002236 Does not change the jumplist.
2237 If {lnum} is greater than the number of lines in the buffer,
2238 the cursor will be positioned at the last line in the buffer.
2239 If {lnum} is zero, the cursor will stay in the current line.
Bram Moolenaar6f16eb82005-08-23 21:02:42 +00002240 If {col} is greater than the number of bytes in the line,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002241 the cursor will be positioned at the last character in the
2242 line.
2243 If {col} is zero, the cursor will stay in the current column.
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00002244 When 'virtualedit' is used {off} specifies the offset in
2245 screen columns from the start of the character. E.g., a
Bram Moolenaard46bbc72007-05-12 14:38:41 +00002246 position within a <Tab> or after the last character.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002247
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00002248
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002249deepcopy({expr}[, {noref}]) *deepcopy()* *E698*
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00002250 Make a copy of {expr}. For Numbers and Strings this isn't
2251 different from using {expr} directly.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002252 When {expr} is a |List| a full copy is created. This means
2253 that the original |List| can be changed without changing the
2254 copy, and vise versa. When an item is a |List|, a copy for it
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00002255 is made, recursively. Thus changing an item in the copy does
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002256 not change the contents of the original |List|.
2257 When {noref} is omitted or zero a contained |List| or
2258 |Dictionary| is only copied once. All references point to
2259 this single copy. With {noref} set to 1 every occurrence of a
2260 |List| or |Dictionary| results in a new copy. This also means
2261 that a cyclic reference causes deepcopy() to fail.
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00002262 *E724*
2263 Nesting is possible up to 100 levels. When there is an item
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00002264 that refers back to a higher level making a deep copy with
2265 {noref} set to 1 will fail.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00002266 Also see |copy()|.
2267
2268delete({fname}) *delete()*
2269 Deletes the file by the name {fname}. The result is a Number,
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002270 which is 0 if the file was deleted successfully, and non-zero
2271 when the deletion failed.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002272 Use |remove()| to delete an item from a |List|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002273
2274 *did_filetype()*
2275did_filetype() Returns non-zero when autocommands are being executed and the
2276 FileType event has been triggered at least once. Can be used
2277 to avoid triggering the FileType event again in the scripts
2278 that detect the file type. |FileType|
2279 When editing another file, the counter is reset, thus this
2280 really checks if the FileType event has been triggered for the
2281 current buffer. This allows an autocommand that starts
2282 editing another buffer to set 'filetype' and load a syntax
2283 file.
2284
Bram Moolenaar47136d72004-10-12 20:02:24 +00002285diff_filler({lnum}) *diff_filler()*
2286 Returns the number of filler lines above line {lnum}.
2287 These are the lines that were inserted at this point in
2288 another diff'ed window. These filler lines are shown in the
2289 display but don't exist in the buffer.
2290 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current
2291 line, "'m" mark m, etc.
2292 Returns 0 if the current window is not in diff mode.
2293
2294diff_hlID({lnum}, {col}) *diff_hlID()*
2295 Returns the highlight ID for diff mode at line {lnum} column
2296 {col} (byte index). When the current line does not have a
2297 diff change zero is returned.
2298 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current
2299 line, "'m" mark m, etc.
2300 {col} is 1 for the leftmost column, {lnum} is 1 for the first
2301 line.
2302 The highlight ID can be used with |synIDattr()| to obtain
2303 syntax information about the highlighting.
2304
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +00002305empty({expr}) *empty()*
2306 Return the Number 1 if {expr} is empty, zero otherwise.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002307 A |List| or |Dictionary| is empty when it does not have any
2308 items. A Number is empty when its value is zero.
2309 For a long |List| this is much faster then comparing the
2310 length with zero.
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +00002311
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002312escape({string}, {chars}) *escape()*
2313 Escape the characters in {chars} that occur in {string} with a
2314 backslash. Example: >
2315 :echo escape('c:\program files\vim', ' \')
2316< results in: >
2317 c:\\program\ files\\vim
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00002318
2319< *eval()*
2320eval({string}) Evaluate {string} and return the result. Especially useful to
2321 turn the result of |string()| back into the original value.
2322 This works for Numbers, Strings and composites of them.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002323 Also works for |Funcref|s that refer to existing functions.
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00002324
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002325eventhandler() *eventhandler()*
2326 Returns 1 when inside an event handler. That is that Vim got
2327 interrupted while waiting for the user to type a character,
2328 e.g., when dropping a file on Vim. This means interactive
2329 commands cannot be used. Otherwise zero is returned.
2330
2331executable({expr}) *executable()*
2332 This function checks if an executable with the name {expr}
2333 exists. {expr} must be the name of the program without any
Bram Moolenaarf4b8e572004-06-24 15:53:16 +00002334 arguments.
2335 executable() uses the value of $PATH and/or the normal
2336 searchpath for programs. *PATHEXT*
2337 On MS-DOS and MS-Windows the ".exe", ".bat", etc. can
2338 optionally be included. Then the extensions in $PATHEXT are
2339 tried. Thus if "foo.exe" does not exist, "foo.exe.bat" can be
2340 found. If $PATHEXT is not set then ".exe;.com;.bat;.cmd" is
2341 used. A dot by itself can be used in $PATHEXT to try using
2342 the name without an extension. When 'shell' looks like a
2343 Unix shell, then the name is also tried without adding an
2344 extension.
2345 On MS-DOS and MS-Windows it only checks if the file exists and
2346 is not a directory, not if it's really executable.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00002347 On MS-Windows an executable in the same directory as Vim is
2348 always found. Since this directory is added to $PATH it
2349 should also work to execute it |win32-PATH|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002350 The result is a Number:
2351 1 exists
2352 0 does not exist
2353 -1 not implemented on this system
2354
2355 *exists()*
2356exists({expr}) The result is a Number, which is non-zero if {expr} is
2357 defined, zero otherwise. The {expr} argument is a string,
2358 which contains one of these:
2359 &option-name Vim option (only checks if it exists,
2360 not if it really works)
2361 +option-name Vim option that works.
2362 $ENVNAME environment variable (could also be
2363 done by comparing with an empty
2364 string)
2365 *funcname built-in function (see |functions|)
2366 or user defined function (see
2367 |user-functions|).
2368 varname internal variable (see
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00002369 |internal-variables|). Also works
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002370 for |curly-braces-names|, |Dictionary|
2371 entries, |List| items, etc. Beware
2372 that this may cause functions to be
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00002373 invoked cause an error message for an
2374 invalid expression.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002375 :cmdname Ex command: built-in command, user
2376 command or command modifier |:command|.
2377 Returns:
2378 1 for match with start of a command
2379 2 full match with a command
2380 3 matches several user commands
2381 To check for a supported command
2382 always check the return value to be 2.
Bram Moolenaar14716812006-05-04 21:54:08 +00002383 :2match The |:2match| command.
2384 :3match The |:3match| command.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002385 #event autocommand defined for this event
2386 #event#pattern autocommand defined for this event and
2387 pattern (the pattern is taken
2388 literally and compared to the
2389 autocommand patterns character by
2390 character)
Bram Moolenaara9b1e742005-12-19 22:14:58 +00002391 #group autocommand group exists
2392 #group#event autocommand defined for this group and
2393 event.
2394 #group#event#pattern
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002395 autocommand defined for this group,
Bram Moolenaara9b1e742005-12-19 22:14:58 +00002396 event and pattern.
Bram Moolenaarf4cd3e82005-12-22 22:47:02 +00002397 ##event autocommand for this event is
2398 supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002399 For checking for a supported feature use |has()|.
2400
2401 Examples: >
2402 exists("&shortname")
2403 exists("$HOSTNAME")
2404 exists("*strftime")
2405 exists("*s:MyFunc")
2406 exists("bufcount")
2407 exists(":Make")
Bram Moolenaara9b1e742005-12-19 22:14:58 +00002408 exists("#CursorHold")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002409 exists("#BufReadPre#*.gz")
Bram Moolenaara9b1e742005-12-19 22:14:58 +00002410 exists("#filetypeindent")
2411 exists("#filetypeindent#FileType")
2412 exists("#filetypeindent#FileType#*")
Bram Moolenaarf4cd3e82005-12-22 22:47:02 +00002413 exists("##ColorScheme")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002414< There must be no space between the symbol (&/$/*/#) and the
2415 name.
Bram Moolenaar91170f82006-05-05 21:15:17 +00002416 There must be no extra characters after the name, although in
2417 a few cases this is ignored. That may become more strict in
2418 the future, thus don't count on it!
2419 Working example: >
2420 exists(":make")
2421< NOT working example: >
2422 exists(":make install")
Bram Moolenaar9c102382006-05-03 21:26:49 +00002423
2424< Note that the argument must be a string, not the name of the
2425 variable itself. For example: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002426 exists(bufcount)
2427< This doesn't check for existence of the "bufcount" variable,
Bram Moolenaar06a89a52006-04-29 22:01:03 +00002428 but gets the value of "bufcount", and checks if that exists.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002429
2430expand({expr} [, {flag}]) *expand()*
2431 Expand wildcards and the following special keywords in {expr}.
2432 The result is a String.
2433
2434 When there are several matches, they are separated by <NL>
2435 characters. [Note: in version 5.0 a space was used, which
2436 caused problems when a file name contains a space]
2437
2438 If the expansion fails, the result is an empty string. A name
2439 for a non-existing file is not included.
2440
2441 When {expr} starts with '%', '#' or '<', the expansion is done
2442 like for the |cmdline-special| variables with their associated
2443 modifiers. Here is a short overview:
2444
2445 % current file name
2446 # alternate file name
2447 #n alternate file name n
2448 <cfile> file name under the cursor
2449 <afile> autocmd file name
2450 <abuf> autocmd buffer number (as a String!)
2451 <amatch> autocmd matched name
2452 <sfile> sourced script file name
2453 <cword> word under the cursor
2454 <cWORD> WORD under the cursor
2455 <client> the {clientid} of the last received
2456 message |server2client()|
2457 Modifiers:
2458 :p expand to full path
2459 :h head (last path component removed)
2460 :t tail (last path component only)
2461 :r root (one extension removed)
2462 :e extension only
2463
2464 Example: >
2465 :let &tags = expand("%:p:h") . "/tags"
2466< Note that when expanding a string that starts with '%', '#' or
2467 '<', any following text is ignored. This does NOT work: >
2468 :let doesntwork = expand("%:h.bak")
2469< Use this: >
2470 :let doeswork = expand("%:h") . ".bak"
2471< Also note that expanding "<cfile>" and others only returns the
2472 referenced file name without further expansion. If "<cfile>"
2473 is "~/.cshrc", you need to do another expand() to have the
2474 "~/" expanded into the path of the home directory: >
2475 :echo expand(expand("<cfile>"))
2476<
2477 There cannot be white space between the variables and the
2478 following modifier. The |fnamemodify()| function can be used
2479 to modify normal file names.
2480
2481 When using '%' or '#', and the current or alternate file name
2482 is not defined, an empty string is used. Using "%:p" in a
2483 buffer with no name, results in the current directory, with a
2484 '/' added.
2485
2486 When {expr} does not start with '%', '#' or '<', it is
2487 expanded like a file name is expanded on the command line.
2488 'suffixes' and 'wildignore' are used, unless the optional
2489 {flag} argument is given and it is non-zero. Names for
Bram Moolenaar02743632005-07-25 20:42:36 +00002490 non-existing files are included. The "**" item can be used to
2491 search in a directory tree. For example, to find all "README"
2492 files in the current directory and below: >
2493 :echo expand("**/README")
2494<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002495 Expand() can also be used to expand variables and environment
2496 variables that are only known in a shell. But this can be
2497 slow, because a shell must be started. See |expr-env-expand|.
2498 The expanded variable is still handled like a list of file
2499 names. When an environment variable cannot be expanded, it is
2500 left unchanged. Thus ":echo expand('$FOOBAR')" results in
2501 "$FOOBAR".
2502
2503 See |glob()| for finding existing files. See |system()| for
2504 getting the raw output of an external command.
2505
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002506extend({expr1}, {expr2} [, {expr3}]) *extend()*
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00002507 {expr1} and {expr2} must be both |Lists| or both
2508 |Dictionaries|.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002509
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00002510 If they are |Lists|: Append {expr2} to {expr1}.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002511 If {expr3} is given insert the items of {expr2} before item
2512 {expr3} in {expr1}. When {expr3} is zero insert before the
2513 first item. When {expr3} is equal to len({expr1}) then
2514 {expr2} is appended.
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00002515 Examples: >
2516 :echo sort(extend(mylist, [7, 5]))
2517 :call extend(mylist, [2, 3], 1)
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00002518< Use |add()| to concatenate one item to a list. To concatenate
2519 two lists into a new list use the + operator: >
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00002520 :let newlist = [1, 2, 3] + [4, 5]
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002521<
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00002522 If they are |Dictionaries|:
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002523 Add all entries from {expr2} to {expr1}.
2524 If a key exists in both {expr1} and {expr2} then {expr3} is
2525 used to decide what to do:
2526 {expr3} = "keep": keep the value of {expr1}
2527 {expr3} = "force": use the value of {expr2}
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00002528 {expr3} = "error": give an error message *E737*
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002529 When {expr3} is omitted then "force" is assumed.
2530
2531 {expr1} is changed when {expr2} is not empty. If necessary
2532 make a copy of {expr1} first.
2533 {expr2} remains unchanged.
2534 Returns {expr1}.
2535
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00002536
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00002537feedkeys({string} [, {mode}]) *feedkeys()*
2538 Characters in {string} are queued for processing as if they
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00002539 come from a mapping or were typed by the user. They are added
2540 to the end of the typeahead buffer, thus if a mapping is still
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00002541 being executed these characters come after them.
2542 The function does not wait for processing of keys contained in
2543 {string}.
2544 To include special keys into {string}, use double-quotes
2545 and "\..." notation |expr-quote|. For example,
Bram Moolenaar79166c42007-05-10 18:29:51 +00002546 feedkeys("\<CR>") simulates pressing of the <Enter> key. But
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00002547 feedkeys('\<CR>') pushes 5 characters.
2548 If {mode} is absent, keys are remapped.
2549 {mode} is a String, which can contain these character flags:
Bram Moolenaar551dbcc2006-04-25 22:13:59 +00002550 'm' Remap keys. This is default.
2551 'n' Do not remap keys.
2552 't' Handle keys as if typed; otherwise they are handled as
2553 if coming from a mapping. This matters for undo,
2554 opening folds, etc.
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00002555 Return value is always 0.
2556
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002557filereadable({file}) *filereadable()*
2558 The result is a Number, which is TRUE when a file with the
2559 name {file} exists, and can be read. If {file} doesn't exist,
2560 or is a directory, the result is FALSE. {file} is any
2561 expression, which is used as a String.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00002562 If you don't care about the file being readable you can use
2563 |glob()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002564 *file_readable()*
2565 Obsolete name: file_readable().
2566
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00002567
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00002568filewritable({file}) *filewritable()*
2569 The result is a Number, which is 1 when a file with the
2570 name {file} exists, and can be written. If {file} doesn't
2571 exist, or is not writable, the result is 0. If (file) is a
2572 directory, and we can write to it, the result is 2.
2573
2574
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002575filter({expr}, {string}) *filter()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002576 {expr} must be a |List| or a |Dictionary|.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002577 For each item in {expr} evaluate {string} and when the result
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002578 is zero remove the item from the |List| or |Dictionary|.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002579 Inside {string} |v:val| has the value of the current item.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002580 For a |Dictionary| |v:key| has the key of the current item.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002581 Examples: >
2582 :call filter(mylist, 'v:val !~ "OLD"')
2583< Removes the items where "OLD" appears. >
2584 :call filter(mydict, 'v:key >= 8')
2585< Removes the items with a key below 8. >
2586 :call filter(var, 0)
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002587< Removes all the items, thus clears the |List| or |Dictionary|.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00002588
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002589 Note that {string} is the result of expression and is then
2590 used as an expression again. Often it is good to use a
2591 |literal-string| to avoid having to double backslashes.
2592
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002593 The operation is done in-place. If you want a |List| or
2594 |Dictionary| to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
Bram Moolenaarafeb4fa2006-02-01 21:51:12 +00002595 :let l = filter(copy(mylist), 'v:val =~ "KEEP"')
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002596
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002597< Returns {expr}, the |List| or |Dictionary| that was filtered.
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00002598 When an error is encountered while evaluating {string} no
2599 further items in {expr} are processed.
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00002600
2601
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00002602finddir({name}[, {path}[, {count}]]) *finddir()*
Bram Moolenaar5b6b1ca2007-03-27 08:19:43 +00002603 Find directory {name} in {path}. Supports both downwards and
2604 upwards recursive directory searches. See |file-searching|
2605 for the syntax of {path}.
2606 Returns the path of the first found match. When the found
2607 directory is below the current directory a relative path is
2608 returned. Otherwise a full path is returned.
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00002609 If {path} is omitted or empty then 'path' is used.
2610 If the optional {count} is given, find {count}'s occurrence of
Bram Moolenaar433f7c82006-03-21 21:29:36 +00002611 {name} in {path} instead of the first one.
Bram Moolenaar899dddf2006-03-26 21:06:50 +00002612 When {count} is negative return all the matches in a |List|.
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00002613 This is quite similar to the ex-command |:find|.
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00002614 {only available when compiled with the +file_in_path feature}
2615
2616findfile({name}[, {path}[, {count}]]) *findfile()*
2617 Just like |finddir()|, but find a file instead of a directory.
Bram Moolenaar433f7c82006-03-21 21:29:36 +00002618 Uses 'suffixesadd'.
2619 Example: >
2620 :echo findfile("tags.vim", ".;")
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00002621< Searches from the directory of the current file upwards until
2622 it finds the file "tags.vim".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002623
Bram Moolenaaraebaf892008-05-28 14:49:58 +00002624fnameescape({string}) *fnameescape()*
2625 Escape {string} for use as file name command argument. All
2626 characters that have a special meaning, such as '%' and '|'
2627 are escaped with a backslash.
2628 For most systems the characters escaped are "". For systems
2629 where a backslash appears in a filename, it depends on the
2630 value of 'isfname'.
2631 Example: >
2632 :let fname = 'some str%nge|name'
2633 :exe "edit " . fnameescape(fname)
2634< results in executing: >
2635 edit some\ str\%nge\|name
2636
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002637fnamemodify({fname}, {mods}) *fnamemodify()*
2638 Modify file name {fname} according to {mods}. {mods} is a
2639 string of characters like it is used for file names on the
2640 command line. See |filename-modifiers|.
2641 Example: >
2642 :echo fnamemodify("main.c", ":p:h")
2643< results in: >
2644 /home/mool/vim/vim/src
2645< Note: Environment variables and "~" don't work in {fname}, use
2646 |expand()| first then.
2647
2648foldclosed({lnum}) *foldclosed()*
2649 The result is a Number. If the line {lnum} is in a closed
2650 fold, the result is the number of the first line in that fold.
2651 If the line {lnum} is not in a closed fold, -1 is returned.
2652
2653foldclosedend({lnum}) *foldclosedend()*
2654 The result is a Number. If the line {lnum} is in a closed
2655 fold, the result is the number of the last line in that fold.
2656 If the line {lnum} is not in a closed fold, -1 is returned.
2657
2658foldlevel({lnum}) *foldlevel()*
2659 The result is a Number, which is the foldlevel of line {lnum}
2660 in the current buffer. For nested folds the deepest level is
2661 returned. If there is no fold at line {lnum}, zero is
2662 returned. It doesn't matter if the folds are open or closed.
2663 When used while updating folds (from 'foldexpr') -1 is
2664 returned for lines where folds are still to be updated and the
2665 foldlevel is unknown. As a special case the level of the
2666 previous line is usually available.
2667
2668 *foldtext()*
2669foldtext() Returns a String, to be displayed for a closed fold. This is
2670 the default function used for the 'foldtext' option and should
2671 only be called from evaluating 'foldtext'. It uses the
2672 |v:foldstart|, |v:foldend| and |v:folddashes| variables.
2673 The returned string looks like this: >
2674 +-- 45 lines: abcdef
2675< The number of dashes depends on the foldlevel. The "45" is
2676 the number of lines in the fold. "abcdef" is the text in the
2677 first non-blank line of the fold. Leading white space, "//"
2678 or "/*" and the text from the 'foldmarker' and 'commentstring'
2679 options is removed.
2680 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| feature}
2681
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00002682foldtextresult({lnum}) *foldtextresult()*
2683 Returns the text that is displayed for the closed fold at line
2684 {lnum}. Evaluates 'foldtext' in the appropriate context.
2685 When there is no closed fold at {lnum} an empty string is
2686 returned.
2687 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|. Thus "." is the current
2688 line, "'m" mark m, etc.
2689 Useful when exporting folded text, e.g., to HTML.
2690 {not available when compiled without the |+folding| feature}
2691
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002692 *foreground()*
2693foreground() Move the Vim window to the foreground. Useful when sent from
2694 a client to a Vim server. |remote_send()|
2695 On Win32 systems this might not work, the OS does not always
2696 allow a window to bring itself to the foreground. Use
2697 |remote_foreground()| instead.
2698 {only in the Win32, Athena, Motif and GTK GUI versions and the
2699 Win32 console version}
2700
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00002701
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +00002702function({name}) *function()* *E700*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002703 Return a |Funcref| variable that refers to function {name}.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00002704 {name} can be a user defined function or an internal function.
2705
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00002706
Bram Moolenaar9d2c8c12007-09-25 16:00:00 +00002707garbagecollect([at_exit]) *garbagecollect()*
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00002708 Cleanup unused |Lists| and |Dictionaries| that have circular
Bram Moolenaar39a58ca2005-06-27 22:42:44 +00002709 references. There is hardly ever a need to invoke this
2710 function, as it is automatically done when Vim runs out of
2711 memory or is waiting for the user to press a key after
2712 'updatetime'. Items without circular references are always
2713 freed when they become unused.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002714 This is useful if you have deleted a very big |List| and/or
2715 |Dictionary| with circular references in a script that runs
2716 for a long time.
Bram Moolenaar9d2c8c12007-09-25 16:00:00 +00002717 When the optional "at_exit" argument is one, garbage
2718 collection will also be done when exiting Vim, if it wasn't
2719 done before. This is useful when checking for memory leaks.
Bram Moolenaar39a58ca2005-06-27 22:42:44 +00002720
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00002721get({list}, {idx} [, {default}]) *get()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002722 Get item {idx} from |List| {list}. When this item is not
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00002723 available return {default}. Return zero when {default} is
2724 omitted.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002725get({dict}, {key} [, {default}])
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002726 Get item with key {key} from |Dictionary| {dict}. When this
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00002727 item is not available return {default}. Return zero when
2728 {default} is omitted.
2729
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00002730 *getbufline()*
2731getbufline({expr}, {lnum} [, {end}])
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002732 Return a |List| with the lines starting from {lnum} to {end}
2733 (inclusive) in the buffer {expr}. If {end} is omitted, a
2734 |List| with only the line {lnum} is returned.
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00002735
2736 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above.
2737
Bram Moolenaar661b1822005-07-28 22:36:45 +00002738 For {lnum} and {end} "$" can be used for the last line of the
2739 buffer. Otherwise a number must be used.
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00002740
2741 When {lnum} is smaller than 1 or bigger than the number of
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002742 lines in the buffer, an empty |List| is returned.
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00002743
2744 When {end} is greater than the number of lines in the buffer,
2745 it is treated as {end} is set to the number of lines in the
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002746 buffer. When {end} is before {lnum} an empty |List| is
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00002747 returned.
2748
Bram Moolenaar661b1822005-07-28 22:36:45 +00002749 This function works only for loaded buffers. For unloaded and
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002750 non-existing buffers, an empty |List| is returned.
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00002751
2752 Example: >
2753 :let lines = getbufline(bufnr("myfile"), 1, "$")
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00002754
2755getbufvar({expr}, {varname}) *getbufvar()*
2756 The result is the value of option or local buffer variable
2757 {varname} in buffer {expr}. Note that the name without "b:"
2758 must be used.
Bram Moolenaar4317d9b2005-03-18 20:25:31 +00002759 This also works for a global or buffer-local option, but it
2760 doesn't work for a global variable, window-local variable or
2761 window-local option.
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00002762 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above.
2763 When the buffer or variable doesn't exist an empty string is
2764 returned, there is no error message.
2765 Examples: >
2766 :let bufmodified = getbufvar(1, "&mod")
2767 :echo "todo myvar = " . getbufvar("todo", "myvar")
2768<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002769getchar([expr]) *getchar()*
Bram Moolenaar91170f82006-05-05 21:15:17 +00002770 Get a single character from the user or input stream.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002771 If [expr] is omitted, wait until a character is available.
2772 If [expr] is 0, only get a character when one is available.
Bram Moolenaar91170f82006-05-05 21:15:17 +00002773 Return zero otherwise.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002774 If [expr] is 1, only check if a character is available, it is
Bram Moolenaar91170f82006-05-05 21:15:17 +00002775 not consumed. Return zero if no character available.
2776
2777 Without {expr} and when {expr} is 0 a whole character or
2778 special key is returned. If it is an 8-bit character, the
2779 result is a number. Use nr2char() to convert it to a String.
2780 Otherwise a String is returned with the encoded character.
2781 For a special key it's a sequence of bytes starting with 0x80
Bram Moolenaar56a907a2006-05-06 21:44:30 +00002782 (decimal: 128). This is the same value as the string
2783 "\<Key>", e.g., "\<Left>". The returned value is also a
2784 String when a modifier (shift, control, alt) was used that is
2785 not included in the character.
Bram Moolenaar91170f82006-05-05 21:15:17 +00002786
2787 When {expr} is 1 only the first byte is returned. For a
Bram Moolenaar56a907a2006-05-06 21:44:30 +00002788 one-byte character it is the character itself as a number.
2789 Use nr2char() to convert it to a String.
Bram Moolenaar91170f82006-05-05 21:15:17 +00002790
Bram Moolenaar219b8702006-11-01 14:32:36 +00002791 When the user clicks a mouse button, the mouse event will be
2792 returned. The position can then be found in |v:mouse_col|,
2793 |v:mouse_lnum| and |v:mouse_win|. This example positions the
2794 mouse as it would normally happen: >
2795 let c = getchar()
2796 if c == "\<LeftMouse>" && v:mouse_win > 0
2797 exe v:mouse_win . "wincmd w"
2798 exe v:mouse_lnum
2799 exe "normal " . v:mouse_col . "|"
2800 endif
2801<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002802 There is no prompt, you will somehow have to make clear to the
2803 user that a character has to be typed.
2804 There is no mapping for the character.
2805 Key codes are replaced, thus when the user presses the <Del>
2806 key you get the code for the <Del> key, not the raw character
2807 sequence. Examples: >
2808 getchar() == "\<Del>"
2809 getchar() == "\<S-Left>"
2810< This example redefines "f" to ignore case: >
2811 :nmap f :call FindChar()<CR>
2812 :function FindChar()
2813 : let c = nr2char(getchar())
2814 : while col('.') < col('$') - 1
2815 : normal l
2816 : if getline('.')[col('.') - 1] ==? c
2817 : break
2818 : endif
2819 : endwhile
2820 :endfunction
2821
2822getcharmod() *getcharmod()*
2823 The result is a Number which is the state of the modifiers for
2824 the last obtained character with getchar() or in another way.
2825 These values are added together:
2826 2 shift
2827 4 control
2828 8 alt (meta)
2829 16 mouse double click
2830 32 mouse triple click
2831 64 mouse quadruple click
2832 128 Macintosh only: command
2833 Only the modifiers that have not been included in the
2834 character itself are obtained. Thus Shift-a results in "A"
2835 with no modifier.
2836
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002837getcmdline() *getcmdline()*
2838 Return the current command-line. Only works when the command
2839 line is being edited, thus requires use of |c_CTRL-\_e| or
2840 |c_CTRL-R_=|.
2841 Example: >
2842 :cmap <F7> <C-\>eescape(getcmdline(), ' \')<CR>
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00002843< Also see |getcmdtype()|, |getcmdpos()| and |setcmdpos()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002844
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00002845getcmdpos() *getcmdpos()*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002846 Return the position of the cursor in the command line as a
2847 byte count. The first column is 1.
2848 Only works when editing the command line, thus requires use of
2849 |c_CTRL-\_e| or |c_CTRL-R_=|. Returns 0 otherwise.
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00002850 Also see |getcmdtype()|, |setcmdpos()| and |getcmdline()|.
2851
2852getcmdtype() *getcmdtype()*
2853 Return the current command-line type. Possible return values
2854 are:
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00002855 : normal Ex command
2856 > debug mode command |debug-mode|
2857 / forward search command
2858 ? backward search command
2859 @ |input()| command
2860 - |:insert| or |:append| command
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00002861 Only works when editing the command line, thus requires use of
2862 |c_CTRL-\_e| or |c_CTRL-R_=|. Returns an empty string
2863 otherwise.
2864 Also see |getcmdpos()|, |setcmdpos()| and |getcmdline()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002865
2866 *getcwd()*
2867getcwd() The result is a String, which is the name of the current
2868 working directory.
2869
2870getfsize({fname}) *getfsize()*
2871 The result is a Number, which is the size in bytes of the
2872 given file {fname}.
2873 If {fname} is a directory, 0 is returned.
2874 If the file {fname} can't be found, -1 is returned.
Bram Moolenaard827ada2007-06-19 15:19:55 +00002875 If the size of {fname} is too big to fit in a Number then -2
2876 is returned.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002877
Bram Moolenaard8b0cf12004-12-12 11:33:30 +00002878getfontname([{name}]) *getfontname()*
2879 Without an argument returns the name of the normal font being
2880 used. Like what is used for the Normal highlight group
2881 |hl-Normal|.
2882 With an argument a check is done whether {name} is a valid
2883 font name. If not then an empty string is returned.
2884 Otherwise the actual font name is returned, or {name} if the
2885 GUI does not support obtaining the real name.
Bram Moolenaarc6fe9192006-04-09 21:54:49 +00002886 Only works when the GUI is running, thus not in your vimrc or
Bram Moolenaard8b0cf12004-12-12 11:33:30 +00002887 gvimrc file. Use the |GUIEnter| autocommand to use this
2888 function just after the GUI has started.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00002889 Note that the GTK 2 GUI accepts any font name, thus checking
2890 for a valid name does not work.
Bram Moolenaard8b0cf12004-12-12 11:33:30 +00002891
Bram Moolenaar5eb86f92004-07-26 12:53:41 +00002892getfperm({fname}) *getfperm()*
2893 The result is a String, which is the read, write, and execute
2894 permissions of the given file {fname}.
2895 If {fname} does not exist or its directory cannot be read, an
2896 empty string is returned.
2897 The result is of the form "rwxrwxrwx", where each group of
2898 "rwx" flags represent, in turn, the permissions of the owner
2899 of the file, the group the file belongs to, and other users.
2900 If a user does not have a given permission the flag for this
2901 is replaced with the string "-". Example: >
2902 :echo getfperm("/etc/passwd")
2903< This will hopefully (from a security point of view) display
2904 the string "rw-r--r--" or even "rw-------".
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00002905
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002906getftime({fname}) *getftime()*
2907 The result is a Number, which is the last modification time of
2908 the given file {fname}. The value is measured as seconds
2909 since 1st Jan 1970, and may be passed to strftime(). See also
2910 |localtime()| and |strftime()|.
2911 If the file {fname} can't be found -1 is returned.
2912
Bram Moolenaar5eb86f92004-07-26 12:53:41 +00002913getftype({fname}) *getftype()*
2914 The result is a String, which is a description of the kind of
2915 file of the given file {fname}.
2916 If {fname} does not exist an empty string is returned.
2917 Here is a table over different kinds of files and their
2918 results:
2919 Normal file "file"
2920 Directory "dir"
2921 Symbolic link "link"
2922 Block device "bdev"
2923 Character device "cdev"
2924 Socket "socket"
2925 FIFO "fifo"
2926 All other "other"
2927 Example: >
2928 getftype("/home")
2929< Note that a type such as "link" will only be returned on
2930 systems that support it. On some systems only "dir" and
2931 "file" are returned.
2932
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002933 *getline()*
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00002934getline({lnum} [, {end}])
2935 Without {end} the result is a String, which is line {lnum}
2936 from the current buffer. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00002937 getline(1)
2938< When {lnum} is a String that doesn't start with a
2939 digit, line() is called to translate the String into a Number.
2940 To get the line under the cursor: >
2941 getline(".")
2942< When {lnum} is smaller than 1 or bigger than the number of
2943 lines in the buffer, an empty string is returned.
2944
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002945 When {end} is given the result is a |List| where each item is
2946 a line from the current buffer in the range {lnum} to {end},
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00002947 including line {end}.
2948 {end} is used in the same way as {lnum}.
2949 Non-existing lines are silently omitted.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00002950 When {end} is before {lnum} an empty |List| is returned.
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00002951 Example: >
2952 :let start = line('.')
2953 :let end = search("^$") - 1
2954 :let lines = getline(start, end)
2955
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00002956< To get lines from another buffer see |getbufline()|
2957
Bram Moolenaar17c7c012006-01-26 22:25:15 +00002958getloclist({nr}) *getloclist()*
2959 Returns a list with all the entries in the location list for
2960 window {nr}. When {nr} is zero the current window is used.
2961 For a location list window, the displayed location list is
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00002962 returned. For an invalid window number {nr}, an empty list is
2963 returned. Otherwise, same as getqflist().
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00002964
Bram Moolenaar6ee10162007-07-26 20:58:42 +00002965getmatches() *getmatches()*
2966 Returns a |List| with all matches previously defined by
2967 |matchadd()| and the |:match| commands. |getmatches()| is
2968 useful in combination with |setmatches()|, as |setmatches()|
2969 can restore a list of matches saved by |getmatches()|.
2970 Example: >
2971 :echo getmatches()
2972< [{'group': 'MyGroup1', 'pattern': 'TODO',
2973 'priority': 10, 'id': 1}, {'group': 'MyGroup2',
2974 'pattern': 'FIXME', 'priority': 10, 'id': 2}] >
2975 :let m = getmatches()
2976 :call clearmatches()
2977 :echo getmatches()
2978< [] >
2979 :call setmatches(m)
2980 :echo getmatches()
2981< [{'group': 'MyGroup1', 'pattern': 'TODO',
2982 'priority': 10, 'id': 1}, {'group': 'MyGroup2',
2983 'pattern': 'FIXME', 'priority': 10, 'id': 2}] >
2984 :unlet m
2985<
2986
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00002987getqflist() *getqflist()*
2988 Returns a list with all the current quickfix errors. Each
2989 list item is a dictionary with these entries:
2990 bufnr number of buffer that has the file name, use
2991 bufname() to get the name
2992 lnum line number in the buffer (first line is 1)
2993 col column number (first column is 1)
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00002994 vcol non-zero: "col" is visual column
2995 zero: "col" is byte index
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00002996 nr error number
Bram Moolenaar48b66fb2007-02-04 01:58:18 +00002997 pattern search pattern used to locate the error
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00002998 text description of the error
2999 type type of the error, 'E', '1', etc.
3000 valid non-zero: recognized error message
3001
Bram Moolenaare7eb9df2005-09-09 19:49:30 +00003002 When there is no error list or it's empty an empty list is
Bram Moolenaar48b66fb2007-02-04 01:58:18 +00003003 returned. Quickfix list entries with non-existing buffer
3004 number are returned with "bufnr" set to zero.
Bram Moolenaare7eb9df2005-09-09 19:49:30 +00003005
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00003006 Useful application: Find pattern matches in multiple files and
3007 do something with them: >
3008 :vimgrep /theword/jg *.c
3009 :for d in getqflist()
3010 : echo bufname(d.bufnr) ':' d.lnum '=' d.text
3011 :endfor
3012
3013
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00003014getreg([{regname} [, 1]]) *getreg()*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003015 The result is a String, which is the contents of register
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00003016 {regname}. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003017 :let cliptext = getreg('*')
3018< getreg('=') returns the last evaluated value of the expression
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00003019 register. (For use in maps.)
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00003020 getreg('=', 1) returns the expression itself, so that it can
3021 be restored with |setreg()|. For other registers the extra
3022 argument is ignored, thus you can always give it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003023 If {regname} is not specified, |v:register| is used.
3024
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00003025
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003026getregtype([{regname}]) *getregtype()*
3027 The result is a String, which is type of register {regname}.
3028 The value will be one of:
3029 "v" for |characterwise| text
3030 "V" for |linewise| text
3031 "<CTRL-V>{width}" for |blockwise-visual| text
3032 0 for an empty or unknown register
3033 <CTRL-V> is one character with value 0x16.
3034 If {regname} is not specified, |v:register| is used.
3035
Bram Moolenaarc6249bb2006-04-15 20:25:09 +00003036gettabwinvar({tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname}) *gettabwinvar()*
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00003037 Get the value of window-local variable {varname} in window
3038 {winnr} in tab page {tabnr}.
3039 When {varname} starts with "&" get the value of a window-local
3040 option.
Bram Moolenaarc6249bb2006-04-15 20:25:09 +00003041 Tabs are numbered starting with one. For the current tabpage
3042 use |getwinvar()|.
3043 When {winnr} is zero the current window is used.
3044 This also works for a global option, buffer-local option and
3045 window-local option, but it doesn't work for a global variable
3046 or buffer-local variable.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00003047 When {varname} is empty a dictionary with all window-local
3048 variables is returned.
3049 Note that {varname} must be the name without "w:".
Bram Moolenaarc6249bb2006-04-15 20:25:09 +00003050 Examples: >
3051 :let list_is_on = gettabwinvar(1, 2, '&list')
3052 :echo "myvar = " . gettabwinvar(3, 1, 'myvar')
Bram Moolenaard46bbc72007-05-12 14:38:41 +00003053<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003054 *getwinposx()*
3055getwinposx() The result is a Number, which is the X coordinate in pixels of
3056 the left hand side of the GUI Vim window. The result will be
3057 -1 if the information is not available.
3058
3059 *getwinposy()*
3060getwinposy() The result is a Number, which is the Y coordinate in pixels of
3061 the top of the GUI Vim window. The result will be -1 if the
3062 information is not available.
3063
Bram Moolenaarc6249bb2006-04-15 20:25:09 +00003064getwinvar({winnr}, {varname}) *getwinvar()*
3065 Like |gettabwinvar()| for the current tabpage.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003066 Examples: >
3067 :let list_is_on = getwinvar(2, '&list')
3068 :echo "myvar = " . getwinvar(1, 'myvar')
3069<
3070 *glob()*
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00003071glob({expr}) Expand the file wildcards in {expr}. See |wildcards| for the
3072 use of special characters.
3073 The result is a String.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003074 When there are several matches, they are separated by <NL>
3075 characters.
3076 If the expansion fails, the result is an empty string.
3077 A name for a non-existing file is not included.
3078
3079 For most systems backticks can be used to get files names from
3080 any external command. Example: >
3081 :let tagfiles = glob("`find . -name tags -print`")
3082 :let &tags = substitute(tagfiles, "\n", ",", "g")
3083< The result of the program inside the backticks should be one
3084 item per line. Spaces inside an item are allowed.
3085
3086 See |expand()| for expanding special Vim variables. See
3087 |system()| for getting the raw output of an external command.
3088
3089globpath({path}, {expr}) *globpath()*
3090 Perform glob() on all directories in {path} and concatenate
3091 the results. Example: >
3092 :echo globpath(&rtp, "syntax/c.vim")
3093< {path} is a comma-separated list of directory names. Each
3094 directory name is prepended to {expr} and expanded like with
3095 glob(). A path separator is inserted when needed.
3096 To add a comma inside a directory name escape it with a
3097 backslash. Note that on MS-Windows a directory may have a
3098 trailing backslash, remove it if you put a comma after it.
3099 If the expansion fails for one of the directories, there is no
3100 error message.
3101 The 'wildignore' option applies: Names matching one of the
3102 patterns in 'wildignore' will be skipped.
3103
Bram Moolenaar02743632005-07-25 20:42:36 +00003104 The "**" item can be used to search in a directory tree.
3105 For example, to find all "README.txt" files in the directories
3106 in 'runtimepath' and below: >
3107 :echo globpath(&rtp, "**/README.txt")
3108<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003109 *has()*
3110has({feature}) The result is a Number, which is 1 if the feature {feature} is
3111 supported, zero otherwise. The {feature} argument is a
3112 string. See |feature-list| below.
3113 Also see |exists()|.
3114
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00003115
3116has_key({dict}, {key}) *has_key()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003117 The result is a Number, which is 1 if |Dictionary| {dict} has
3118 an entry with key {key}. Zero otherwise.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00003119
Bram Moolenaard267b9c2007-04-26 15:06:45 +00003120haslocaldir() *haslocaldir()*
3121 The result is a Number, which is 1 when the current
3122 window has set a local path via |:lcd|, and 0 otherwise.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00003123
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003124hasmapto({what} [, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) *hasmapto()*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003125 The result is a Number, which is 1 if there is a mapping that
3126 contains {what} in somewhere in the rhs (what it is mapped to)
3127 and this mapping exists in one of the modes indicated by
3128 {mode}.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003129 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations
Bram Moolenaar39f05632006-03-19 22:15:26 +00003130 instead of mappings. Don't forget to specify Insert and/or
3131 Command-line mode.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003132 Both the global mappings and the mappings local to the current
3133 buffer are checked for a match.
3134 If no matching mapping is found 0 is returned.
3135 The following characters are recognized in {mode}:
3136 n Normal mode
3137 v Visual mode
3138 o Operator-pending mode
3139 i Insert mode
3140 l Language-Argument ("r", "f", "t", etc.)
3141 c Command-line mode
3142 When {mode} is omitted, "nvo" is used.
3143
3144 This function is useful to check if a mapping already exists
3145 to a function in a Vim script. Example: >
3146 :if !hasmapto('\ABCdoit')
3147 : map <Leader>d \ABCdoit
3148 :endif
3149< This installs the mapping to "\ABCdoit" only if there isn't
3150 already a mapping to "\ABCdoit".
3151
3152histadd({history}, {item}) *histadd()*
3153 Add the String {item} to the history {history} which can be
3154 one of: *hist-names*
3155 "cmd" or ":" command line history
3156 "search" or "/" search pattern history
3157 "expr" or "=" typed expression history
3158 "input" or "@" input line history
3159 If {item} does already exist in the history, it will be
3160 shifted to become the newest entry.
3161 The result is a Number: 1 if the operation was successful,
3162 otherwise 0 is returned.
3163
3164 Example: >
3165 :call histadd("input", strftime("%Y %b %d"))
3166 :let date=input("Enter date: ")
3167< This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
3168
3169histdel({history} [, {item}]) *histdel()*
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00003170 Clear {history}, i.e. delete all its entries. See |hist-names|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003171 for the possible values of {history}.
3172
3173 If the parameter {item} is given as String, this is seen
3174 as regular expression. All entries matching that expression
3175 will be removed from the history (if there are any).
3176 Upper/lowercase must match, unless "\c" is used |/\c|.
3177 If {item} is a Number, it will be interpreted as index, see
3178 |:history-indexing|. The respective entry will be removed
3179 if it exists.
3180
3181 The result is a Number: 1 for a successful operation,
3182 otherwise 0 is returned.
3183
3184 Examples:
3185 Clear expression register history: >
3186 :call histdel("expr")
3187<
3188 Remove all entries starting with "*" from the search history: >
3189 :call histdel("/", '^\*')
3190<
3191 The following three are equivalent: >
3192 :call histdel("search", histnr("search"))
3193 :call histdel("search", -1)
3194 :call histdel("search", '^'.histget("search", -1).'$')
3195<
3196 To delete the last search pattern and use the last-but-one for
3197 the "n" command and 'hlsearch': >
3198 :call histdel("search", -1)
3199 :let @/ = histget("search", -1)
3200
3201histget({history} [, {index}]) *histget()*
3202 The result is a String, the entry with Number {index} from
3203 {history}. See |hist-names| for the possible values of
3204 {history}, and |:history-indexing| for {index}. If there is
3205 no such entry, an empty String is returned. When {index} is
3206 omitted, the most recent item from the history is used.
3207
3208 Examples:
3209 Redo the second last search from history. >
3210 :execute '/' . histget("search", -2)
3211
3212< Define an Ex command ":H {num}" that supports re-execution of
3213 the {num}th entry from the output of |:history|. >
3214 :command -nargs=1 H execute histget("cmd", 0+<args>)
3215<
3216histnr({history}) *histnr()*
3217 The result is the Number of the current entry in {history}.
3218 See |hist-names| for the possible values of {history}.
3219 If an error occurred, -1 is returned.
3220
3221 Example: >
3222 :let inp_index = histnr("expr")
3223<
3224hlexists({name}) *hlexists()*
3225 The result is a Number, which is non-zero if a highlight group
3226 called {name} exists. This is when the group has been
3227 defined in some way. Not necessarily when highlighting has
3228 been defined for it, it may also have been used for a syntax
3229 item.
3230 *highlight_exists()*
3231 Obsolete name: highlight_exists().
3232
3233 *hlID()*
3234hlID({name}) The result is a Number, which is the ID of the highlight group
3235 with name {name}. When the highlight group doesn't exist,
3236 zero is returned.
3237 This can be used to retrieve information about the highlight
3238 group. For example, to get the background color of the
3239 "Comment" group: >
3240 :echo synIDattr(synIDtrans(hlID("Comment")), "bg")
3241< *highlightID()*
3242 Obsolete name: highlightID().
3243
3244hostname() *hostname()*
3245 The result is a String, which is the name of the machine on
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00003246 which Vim is currently running. Machine names greater than
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003247 256 characters long are truncated.
3248
3249iconv({expr}, {from}, {to}) *iconv()*
3250 The result is a String, which is the text {expr} converted
3251 from encoding {from} to encoding {to}.
3252 When the conversion fails an empty string is returned.
3253 The encoding names are whatever the iconv() library function
3254 can accept, see ":!man 3 iconv".
3255 Most conversions require Vim to be compiled with the |+iconv|
3256 feature. Otherwise only UTF-8 to latin1 conversion and back
3257 can be done.
3258 This can be used to display messages with special characters,
3259 no matter what 'encoding' is set to. Write the message in
3260 UTF-8 and use: >
3261 echo iconv(utf8_str, "utf-8", &enc)
3262< Note that Vim uses UTF-8 for all Unicode encodings, conversion
3263 from/to UCS-2 is automatically changed to use UTF-8. You
3264 cannot use UCS-2 in a string anyway, because of the NUL bytes.
3265 {only available when compiled with the +multi_byte feature}
3266
3267 *indent()*
3268indent({lnum}) The result is a Number, which is indent of line {lnum} in the
3269 current buffer. The indent is counted in spaces, the value
3270 of 'tabstop' is relevant. {lnum} is used just like in
3271 |getline()|.
3272 When {lnum} is invalid -1 is returned.
3273
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00003274
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003275index({list}, {expr} [, {start} [, {ic}]]) *index()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003276 Return the lowest index in |List| {list} where the item has a
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00003277 value equal to {expr}.
Bram Moolenaar748bf032005-02-02 23:04:36 +00003278 If {start} is given then start looking at the item with index
3279 {start} (may be negative for an item relative to the end).
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00003280 When {ic} is given and it is non-zero, ignore case. Otherwise
3281 case must match.
3282 -1 is returned when {expr} is not found in {list}.
3283 Example: >
3284 :let idx = index(words, "the")
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00003285 :if index(numbers, 123) >= 0
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00003286
3287
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00003288input({prompt} [, {text} [, {completion}]]) *input()*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003289 The result is a String, which is whatever the user typed on
3290 the command-line. The parameter is either a prompt string, or
3291 a blank string (for no prompt). A '\n' can be used in the
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00003292 prompt to start a new line.
3293 The highlighting set with |:echohl| is used for the prompt.
3294 The input is entered just like a command-line, with the same
3295 editing commands and mappings. There is a separate history
3296 for lines typed for input().
3297 Example: >
3298 :if input("Coffee or beer? ") == "beer"
3299 : echo "Cheers!"
3300 :endif
3301<
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00003302 If the optional {text} is present and not empty, this is used
3303 for the default reply, as if the user typed this. Example: >
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00003304 :let color = input("Color? ", "white")
3305
3306< The optional {completion} argument specifies the type of
3307 completion supported for the input. Without it completion is
3308 not performed. The supported completion types are the same as
3309 that can be supplied to a user-defined command using the
3310 "-complete=" argument. Refer to |:command-completion| for
3311 more information. Example: >
3312 let fname = input("File: ", "", "file")
3313<
3314 NOTE: This function must not be used in a startup file, for
3315 the versions that only run in GUI mode (e.g., the Win32 GUI).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003316 Note: When input() is called from within a mapping it will
3317 consume remaining characters from that mapping, because a
3318 mapping is handled like the characters were typed.
3319 Use |inputsave()| before input() and |inputrestore()|
3320 after input() to avoid that. Another solution is to avoid
3321 that further characters follow in the mapping, e.g., by using
3322 |:execute| or |:normal|.
3323
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00003324 Example with a mapping: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003325 :nmap \x :call GetFoo()<CR>:exe "/" . Foo<CR>
3326 :function GetFoo()
3327 : call inputsave()
3328 : let g:Foo = input("enter search pattern: ")
3329 : call inputrestore()
3330 :endfunction
3331
3332inputdialog({prompt} [, {text} [, {cancelreturn}]]) *inputdialog()*
3333 Like input(), but when the GUI is running and text dialogs are
3334 supported, a dialog window pops up to input the text.
3335 Example: >
3336 :let n = inputdialog("value for shiftwidth", &sw)
3337 :if n != ""
3338 : let &sw = n
3339 :endif
3340< When the dialog is cancelled {cancelreturn} is returned. When
3341 omitted an empty string is returned.
3342 Hitting <Enter> works like pressing the OK button. Hitting
3343 <Esc> works like pressing the Cancel button.
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00003344 NOTE: Command-line completion is not supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003345
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +00003346inputlist({textlist}) *inputlist()*
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003347 {textlist} must be a |List| of strings. This |List| is
3348 displayed, one string per line. The user will be prompted to
3349 enter a number, which is returned.
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +00003350 The user can also select an item by clicking on it with the
3351 mouse. For the first string 0 is returned. When clicking
3352 above the first item a negative number is returned. When
3353 clicking on the prompt one more than the length of {textlist}
3354 is returned.
3355 Make sure {textlist} has less then 'lines' entries, otherwise
3356 it won't work. It's a good idea to put the entry number at
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00003357 the start of the string. And put a prompt in the first item.
3358 Example: >
Bram Moolenaar578b49e2005-09-10 19:22:57 +00003359 let color = inputlist(['Select color:', '1. red',
3360 \ '2. green', '3. blue'])
3361
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003362inputrestore() *inputrestore()*
3363 Restore typeahead that was saved with a previous inputsave().
3364 Should be called the same number of times inputsave() is
3365 called. Calling it more often is harmless though.
3366 Returns 1 when there is nothing to restore, 0 otherwise.
3367
3368inputsave() *inputsave()*
3369 Preserve typeahead (also from mappings) and clear it, so that
3370 a following prompt gets input from the user. Should be
3371 followed by a matching inputrestore() after the prompt. Can
3372 be used several times, in which case there must be just as
3373 many inputrestore() calls.
3374 Returns 1 when out of memory, 0 otherwise.
3375
3376inputsecret({prompt} [, {text}]) *inputsecret()*
3377 This function acts much like the |input()| function with but
3378 two exceptions:
3379 a) the user's response will be displayed as a sequence of
3380 asterisks ("*") thereby keeping the entry secret, and
3381 b) the user's response will not be recorded on the input
3382 |history| stack.
3383 The result is a String, which is whatever the user actually
3384 typed on the command-line in response to the issued prompt.
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00003385 NOTE: Command-line completion is not supported.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003386
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00003387insert({list}, {item} [, {idx}]) *insert()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003388 Insert {item} at the start of |List| {list}.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00003389 If {idx} is specified insert {item} before the item with index
3390 {idx}. If {idx} is zero it goes before the first item, just
3391 like omitting {idx}. A negative {idx} is also possible, see
3392 |list-index|. -1 inserts just before the last item.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003393 Returns the resulting |List|. Examples: >
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00003394 :let mylist = insert([2, 3, 5], 1)
3395 :call insert(mylist, 4, -1)
3396 :call insert(mylist, 6, len(mylist))
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00003397< The last example can be done simpler with |add()|.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003398 Note that when {item} is a |List| it is inserted as a single
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003399 item. Use |extend()| to concatenate |Lists|.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00003400
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003401isdirectory({directory}) *isdirectory()*
3402 The result is a Number, which is non-zero when a directory
3403 with the name {directory} exists. If {directory} doesn't
3404 exist, or isn't a directory, the result is FALSE. {directory}
3405 is any expression, which is used as a String.
3406
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003407islocked({expr}) *islocked()* *E786*
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00003408 The result is a Number, which is non-zero when {expr} is the
3409 name of a locked variable.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003410 {expr} must be the name of a variable, |List| item or
3411 |Dictionary| entry, not the variable itself! Example: >
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00003412 :let alist = [0, ['a', 'b'], 2, 3]
3413 :lockvar 1 alist
3414 :echo islocked('alist') " 1
3415 :echo islocked('alist[1]') " 0
3416
3417< When {expr} is a variable that does not exist you get an error
Bram Moolenaar551dbcc2006-04-25 22:13:59 +00003418 message. Use |exists()| to check for existence.
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00003419
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00003420items({dict}) *items()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003421 Return a |List| with all the key-value pairs of {dict}. Each
3422 |List| item is a list with two items: the key of a {dict}
3423 entry and the value of this entry. The |List| is in arbitrary
3424 order.
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00003425
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003426
3427join({list} [, {sep}]) *join()*
3428 Join the items in {list} together into one String.
3429 When {sep} is specified it is put in between the items. If
3430 {sep} is omitted a single space is used.
3431 Note that {sep} is not added at the end. You might want to
3432 add it there too: >
3433 let lines = join(mylist, "\n") . "\n"
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003434< String items are used as-is. |Lists| and |Dictionaries| are
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003435 converted into a string like with |string()|.
3436 The opposite function is |split()|.
3437
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00003438keys({dict}) *keys()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003439 Return a |List| with all the keys of {dict}. The |List| is in
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00003440 arbitrary order.
3441
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +00003442 *len()* *E701*
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00003443len({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the length of the argument.
3444 When {expr} is a String or a Number the length in bytes is
3445 used, as with |strlen()|.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003446 When {expr} is a |List| the number of items in the |List| is
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00003447 returned.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003448 When {expr} is a |Dictionary| the number of entries in the
3449 |Dictionary| is returned.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00003450 Otherwise an error is given.
3451
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003452 *libcall()* *E364* *E368*
3453libcall({libname}, {funcname}, {argument})
3454 Call function {funcname} in the run-time library {libname}
3455 with single argument {argument}.
3456 This is useful to call functions in a library that you
3457 especially made to be used with Vim. Since only one argument
3458 is possible, calling standard library functions is rather
3459 limited.
3460 The result is the String returned by the function. If the
3461 function returns NULL, this will appear as an empty string ""
3462 to Vim.
3463 If the function returns a number, use libcallnr()!
3464 If {argument} is a number, it is passed to the function as an
3465 int; if {argument} is a string, it is passed as a
3466 null-terminated string.
3467 This function will fail in |restricted-mode|.
3468
3469 libcall() allows you to write your own 'plug-in' extensions to
3470 Vim without having to recompile the program. It is NOT a
3471 means to call system functions! If you try to do so Vim will
3472 very probably crash.
3473
3474 For Win32, the functions you write must be placed in a DLL
3475 and use the normal C calling convention (NOT Pascal which is
3476 used in Windows System DLLs). The function must take exactly
3477 one parameter, either a character pointer or a long integer,
3478 and must return a character pointer or NULL. The character
3479 pointer returned must point to memory that will remain valid
3480 after the function has returned (e.g. in static data in the
3481 DLL). If it points to allocated memory, that memory will
3482 leak away. Using a static buffer in the function should work,
3483 it's then freed when the DLL is unloaded.
3484
3485 WARNING: If the function returns a non-valid pointer, Vim may
3486 crash! This also happens if the function returns a number,
3487 because Vim thinks it's a pointer.
3488 For Win32 systems, {libname} should be the filename of the DLL
3489 without the ".DLL" suffix. A full path is only required if
3490 the DLL is not in the usual places.
3491 For Unix: When compiling your own plugins, remember that the
3492 object code must be compiled as position-independent ('PIC').
3493 {only in Win32 on some Unix versions, when the |+libcall|
3494 feature is present}
3495 Examples: >
3496 :echo libcall("libc.so", "getenv", "HOME")
3497 :echo libcallnr("/usr/lib/libc.so", "getpid", "")
3498<
3499 *libcallnr()*
3500libcallnr({libname}, {funcname}, {argument})
3501 Just like libcall(), but used for a function that returns an
3502 int instead of a string.
3503 {only in Win32 on some Unix versions, when the |+libcall|
3504 feature is present}
3505 Example (not very useful...): >
3506 :call libcallnr("libc.so", "printf", "Hello World!\n")
3507 :call libcallnr("libc.so", "sleep", 10)
3508<
3509 *line()*
3510line({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the line number of the file
3511 position given with {expr}. The accepted positions are:
3512 . the cursor position
3513 $ the last line in the current buffer
3514 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is
3515 returned)
Bram Moolenaarc7453f52006-02-10 23:20:28 +00003516 w0 first line visible in current window
3517 w$ last line visible in current window
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00003518 Note that a mark in another file can be used. The line number
3519 then applies to another buffer.
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00003520 To get the column number use |col()|. To get both use
3521 |getpos()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003522 Examples: >
3523 line(".") line number of the cursor
3524 line("'t") line number of mark t
3525 line("'" . marker) line number of mark marker
3526< *last-position-jump*
3527 This autocommand jumps to the last known position in a file
3528 just after opening it, if the '" mark is set: >
3529 :au BufReadPost * if line("'\"") > 0 && line("'\"") <= line("$") | exe "normal g'\"" | endif
Bram Moolenaar69a7cb42004-06-20 12:51:53 +00003530
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003531line2byte({lnum}) *line2byte()*
3532 Return the byte count from the start of the buffer for line
3533 {lnum}. This includes the end-of-line character, depending on
3534 the 'fileformat' option for the current buffer. The first
3535 line returns 1.
3536 This can also be used to get the byte count for the line just
3537 below the last line: >
3538 line2byte(line("$") + 1)
3539< This is the file size plus one.
3540 When {lnum} is invalid, or the |+byte_offset| feature has been
3541 disabled at compile time, -1 is returned.
3542 Also see |byte2line()|, |go| and |:goto|.
3543
3544lispindent({lnum}) *lispindent()*
3545 Get the amount of indent for line {lnum} according the lisp
3546 indenting rules, as with 'lisp'.
3547 The indent is counted in spaces, the value of 'tabstop' is
3548 relevant. {lnum} is used just like in |getline()|.
3549 When {lnum} is invalid or Vim was not compiled the
3550 |+lispindent| feature, -1 is returned.
3551
3552localtime() *localtime()*
3553 Return the current time, measured as seconds since 1st Jan
3554 1970. See also |strftime()| and |getftime()|.
3555
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003556
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00003557map({expr}, {string}) *map()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003558 {expr} must be a |List| or a |Dictionary|.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00003559 Replace each item in {expr} with the result of evaluating
3560 {string}.
3561 Inside {string} |v:val| has the value of the current item.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003562 For a |Dictionary| |v:key| has the key of the current item.
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00003563 Example: >
3564 :call map(mylist, '"> " . v:val . " <"')
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003565< This puts "> " before and " <" after each item in "mylist".
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00003566
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00003567 Note that {string} is the result of an expression and is then
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00003568 used as an expression again. Often it is good to use a
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00003569 |literal-string| to avoid having to double backslashes. You
3570 still have to double ' quotes
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00003571
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003572 The operation is done in-place. If you want a |List| or
3573 |Dictionary| to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00003574 :let tlist = map(copy(mylist), ' & . "\t"')
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00003575
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003576< Returns {expr}, the |List| or |Dictionary| that was filtered.
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00003577 When an error is encountered while evaluating {string} no
3578 further items in {expr} are processed.
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003579
3580
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003581maparg({name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) *maparg()*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003582 Return the rhs of mapping {name} in mode {mode}. When there
3583 is no mapping for {name}, an empty String is returned.
Bram Moolenaard12f5c12006-01-25 22:10:52 +00003584 {mode} can be one of these strings:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003585 "n" Normal
3586 "v" Visual
3587 "o" Operator-pending
3588 "i" Insert
3589 "c" Cmd-line
3590 "l" langmap |language-mapping|
3591 "" Normal, Visual and Operator-pending
Bram Moolenaard12f5c12006-01-25 22:10:52 +00003592 When {mode} is omitted, the modes for "" are used.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003593 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations
3594 instead of mappings.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003595 The {name} can have special key names, like in the ":map"
3596 command. The returned String has special characters
3597 translated like in the output of the ":map" command listing.
3598 The mappings local to the current buffer are checked first,
3599 then the global mappings.
Bram Moolenaara40ceaf2006-01-13 22:35:40 +00003600 This function can be used to map a key even when it's already
3601 mapped, and have it do the original mapping too. Sketch: >
3602 exe 'nnoremap <Tab> ==' . maparg('<Tab>', 'n')
3603
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003604
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003605mapcheck({name}[, {mode} [, {abbr}]]) *mapcheck()*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003606 Check if there is a mapping that matches with {name} in mode
3607 {mode}. See |maparg()| for {mode} and special names in
3608 {name}.
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00003609 When {abbr} is there and it is non-zero use abbreviations
3610 instead of mappings.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003611 A match happens with a mapping that starts with {name} and
3612 with a mapping which is equal to the start of {name}.
3613
3614 matches mapping "a" "ab" "abc" ~
3615 mapcheck("a") yes yes yes
3616 mapcheck("abc") yes yes yes
3617 mapcheck("ax") yes no no
3618 mapcheck("b") no no no
3619
3620 The difference with maparg() is that mapcheck() finds a
3621 mapping that matches with {name}, while maparg() only finds a
3622 mapping for {name} exactly.
3623 When there is no mapping that starts with {name}, an empty
3624 String is returned. If there is one, the rhs of that mapping
3625 is returned. If there are several mappings that start with
3626 {name}, the rhs of one of them is returned.
3627 The mappings local to the current buffer are checked first,
3628 then the global mappings.
3629 This function can be used to check if a mapping can be added
3630 without being ambiguous. Example: >
3631 :if mapcheck("_vv") == ""
3632 : map _vv :set guifont=7x13<CR>
3633 :endif
3634< This avoids adding the "_vv" mapping when there already is a
3635 mapping for "_v" or for "_vvv".
3636
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00003637match({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *match()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003638 When {expr} is a |List| then this returns the index of the
3639 first item where {pat} matches. Each item is used as a
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00003640 String, |Lists| and |Dictionaries| are used as echoed.
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003641 Otherwise, {expr} is used as a String. The result is a
3642 Number, which gives the index (byte offset) in {expr} where
3643 {pat} matches.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003644 A match at the first character or |List| item returns zero.
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00003645 If there is no match -1 is returned.
3646 Example: >
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003647 :echo match("testing", "ing") " results in 4
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00003648 :echo match([1, 'x'], '\a') " results in 1
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003649< See |string-match| for how {pat} is used.
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00003650 *strpbrk()*
3651 Vim doesn't have a strpbrk() function. But you can do: >
3652 :let sepidx = match(line, '[.,;: \t]')
3653< *strcasestr()*
3654 Vim doesn't have a strcasestr() function. But you can add
3655 "\c" to the pattern to ignore case: >
3656 :let idx = match(haystack, '\cneedle')
3657<
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003658 If {start} is given, the search starts from byte index
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003659 {start} in a String or item {start} in a |List|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003660 The result, however, is still the index counted from the
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00003661 first character/item. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003662 :echo match("testing", "ing", 2)
3663< result is again "4". >
3664 :echo match("testing", "ing", 4)
3665< result is again "4". >
3666 :echo match("testing", "t", 2)
3667< result is "3".
Bram Moolenaar5e3cb7e2006-02-27 23:58:35 +00003668 For a String, if {start} > 0 then it is like the string starts
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00003669 {start} bytes later, thus "^" will match at {start}. Except
3670 when {count} is given, then it's like matches before the
3671 {start} byte are ignored (this is a bit complicated to keep it
3672 backwards compatible).
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003673 For a String, if {start} < 0, it will be set to 0. For a list
3674 the index is counted from the end.
Bram Moolenaare224ffa2006-03-01 00:01:28 +00003675 If {start} is out of range ({start} > strlen({expr}) for a
3676 String or {start} > len({expr}) for a |List|) -1 is returned.
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003677
Bram Moolenaar5e3cb7e2006-02-27 23:58:35 +00003678 When {count} is given use the {count}'th match. When a match
Bram Moolenaare224ffa2006-03-01 00:01:28 +00003679 is found in a String the search for the next one starts one
Bram Moolenaar5e3cb7e2006-02-27 23:58:35 +00003680 character further. Thus this example results in 1: >
3681 echo match("testing", "..", 0, 2)
3682< In a |List| the search continues in the next item.
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00003683 Note that when {count} is added the way {start} works changes,
3684 see above.
Bram Moolenaar5e3cb7e2006-02-27 23:58:35 +00003685
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003686 See |pattern| for the patterns that are accepted.
3687 The 'ignorecase' option is used to set the ignore-caseness of
3688 the pattern. 'smartcase' is NOT used. The matching is always
3689 done like 'magic' is set and 'cpoptions' is empty.
3690
Bram Moolenaar6ee10162007-07-26 20:58:42 +00003691 *matchadd()* *E798* *E799* *E801*
3692matchadd({group}, {pattern}[, {priority}[, {id}]])
3693 Defines a pattern to be highlighted in the current window (a
3694 "match"). It will be highlighted with {group}. Returns an
3695 identification number (ID), which can be used to delete the
3696 match using |matchdelete()|.
3697
3698 The optional {priority} argument assigns a priority to the
3699 match. A match with a high priority will have its
3700 highlighting overrule that of a match with a lower priority.
3701 A priority is specified as an integer (negative numbers are no
3702 exception). If the {priority} argument is not specified, the
3703 default priority is 10. The priority of 'hlsearch' is zero,
3704 hence all matches with a priority greater than zero will
3705 overrule it. Syntax highlighting (see 'syntax') is a separate
3706 mechanism, and regardless of the chosen priority a match will
3707 always overrule syntax highlighting.
3708
3709 The optional {id} argument allows the request for a specific
3710 match ID. If a specified ID is already taken, an error
3711 message will appear and the match will not be added. An ID
3712 is specified as a positive integer (zero excluded). IDs 1, 2
3713 and 3 are reserved for |:match|, |:2match| and |:3match|,
3714 respectively. If the {id} argument is not specified,
3715 |matchadd()| automatically chooses a free ID.
3716
3717 The number of matches is not limited, as it is the case with
3718 the |:match| commands.
3719
3720 Example: >
3721 :highlight MyGroup ctermbg=green guibg=green
3722 :let m = matchadd("MyGroup", "TODO")
3723< Deletion of the pattern: >
3724 :call matchdelete(m)
3725
3726< A list of matches defined by |matchadd()| and |:match| are
3727 available from |getmatches()|. All matches can be deleted in
3728 one operation by |clearmatches()|.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003729
3730matcharg({nr}) *matcharg()*
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00003731 Selects the {nr} match item, as set with a |:match|,
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003732 |:2match| or |:3match| command.
3733 Return a |List| with two elements:
3734 The name of the highlight group used
3735 The pattern used.
3736 When {nr} is not 1, 2 or 3 returns an empty |List|.
3737 When there is no match item set returns ['', ''].
Bram Moolenaar6ee10162007-07-26 20:58:42 +00003738 This is useful to save and restore a |:match|.
3739 Highlighting matches using the |:match| commands are limited
3740 to three matches. |matchadd()| does not have this limitation.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003741
Bram Moolenaar6ee10162007-07-26 20:58:42 +00003742matchdelete({id}) *matchdelete()* *E802* *E803*
3743 Deletes a match with ID {id} previously defined by |matchadd()|
3744 or one of the |:match| commands. Returns 0 if succesfull,
3745 otherwise -1. See example for |matchadd()|. All matches can
3746 be deleted in one operation by |clearmatches()|.
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003747
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00003748matchend({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchend()*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003749 Same as match(), but return the index of first character after
3750 the match. Example: >
3751 :echo matchend("testing", "ing")
3752< results in "7".
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00003753 *strspn()* *strcspn()*
3754 Vim doesn't have a strspn() or strcspn() function, but you can
3755 do it with matchend(): >
3756 :let span = matchend(line, '[a-zA-Z]')
3757 :let span = matchend(line, '[^a-zA-Z]')
3758< Except that -1 is returned when there are no matches.
3759
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003760 The {start}, if given, has the same meaning as for match(). >
3761 :echo matchend("testing", "ing", 2)
3762< results in "7". >
3763 :echo matchend("testing", "ing", 5)
3764< result is "-1".
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003765 When {expr} is a |List| the result is equal to match().
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003766
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00003767matchlist({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchlist()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003768 Same as match(), but return a |List|. The first item in the
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00003769 list is the matched string, same as what matchstr() would
3770 return. Following items are submatches, like "\1", "\2", etc.
Bram Moolenaarf9393ef2006-04-24 19:47:27 +00003771 in |:substitute|. When an optional submatch didn't match an
3772 empty string is used. Example: >
3773 echo matchlist('acd', '\(a\)\?\(b\)\?\(c\)\?\(.*\)')
3774< Results in: ['acd', 'a', '', 'c', 'd', '', '', '', '', '']
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00003775 When there is no match an empty list is returned.
3776
Bram Moolenaar89cb5e02004-07-19 20:55:54 +00003777matchstr({expr}, {pat}[, {start}[, {count}]]) *matchstr()*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003778 Same as match(), but return the matched string. Example: >
3779 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing")
3780< results in "ing".
3781 When there is no match "" is returned.
3782 The {start}, if given, has the same meaning as for match(). >
3783 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing", 2)
3784< results in "ing". >
3785 :echo matchstr("testing", "ing", 5)
3786< result is "".
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003787 When {expr} is a |List| then the matching item is returned.
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00003788 The type isn't changed, it's not necessarily a String.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003789
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00003790 *max()*
3791max({list}) Return the maximum value of all items in {list}.
3792 If {list} is not a list or one of the items in {list} cannot
3793 be used as a Number this results in an error.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003794 An empty |List| results in zero.
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00003795
3796 *min()*
Bram Moolenaar79166c42007-05-10 18:29:51 +00003797min({list}) Return the minimum value of all items in {list}.
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00003798 If {list} is not a list or one of the items in {list} cannot
3799 be used as a Number this results in an error.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00003800 An empty |List| results in zero.
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00003801
Bram Moolenaar551dbcc2006-04-25 22:13:59 +00003802 *mkdir()* *E739*
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00003803mkdir({name} [, {path} [, {prot}]])
3804 Create directory {name}.
3805 If {path} is "p" then intermediate directories are created as
3806 necessary. Otherwise it must be "".
3807 If {prot} is given it is used to set the protection bits of
3808 the new directory. The default is 0755 (rwxr-xr-x: r/w for
3809 the user readable for others). Use 0700 to make it unreadable
3810 for others.
3811 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
3812 Not available on all systems. To check use: >
3813 :if exists("*mkdir")
3814<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003815 *mode()*
3816mode() Return a string that indicates the current mode:
3817 n Normal
3818 v Visual by character
3819 V Visual by line
3820 CTRL-V Visual blockwise
3821 s Select by character
3822 S Select by line
3823 CTRL-S Select blockwise
3824 i Insert
3825 R Replace
3826 c Command-line
3827 r Hit-enter prompt
3828 This is useful in the 'statusline' option. In most other
3829 places it always returns "c" or "n".
3830
3831nextnonblank({lnum}) *nextnonblank()*
3832 Return the line number of the first line at or below {lnum}
3833 that is not blank. Example: >
3834 if getline(nextnonblank(1)) =~ "Java"
3835< When {lnum} is invalid or there is no non-blank line at or
3836 below it, zero is returned.
3837 See also |prevnonblank()|.
3838
3839nr2char({expr}) *nr2char()*
3840 Return a string with a single character, which has the number
3841 value {expr}. Examples: >
3842 nr2char(64) returns "@"
3843 nr2char(32) returns " "
3844< The current 'encoding' is used. Example for "utf-8": >
3845 nr2char(300) returns I with bow character
3846< Note that a NUL character in the file is specified with
3847 nr2char(10), because NULs are represented with newline
3848 characters. nr2char(0) is a real NUL and terminates the
Bram Moolenaar383f9bc2005-01-19 22:18:32 +00003849 string, thus results in an empty string.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00003850
Bram Moolenaar18081e32008-02-20 19:11:07 +00003851 *getpid()*
3852getpid() Return a Number which is the process ID of the Vim process.
3853 On Unix this is a unique number. On MS-DOS it's always zero.
3854
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00003855 *getpos()*
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00003856getpos({expr}) Get the position for {expr}. For possible values of {expr}
3857 see |line()|.
3858 The result is a |List| with four numbers:
3859 [bufnum, lnum, col, off]
3860 "bufnum" is zero, unless a mark like '0 or 'A is used, then it
3861 is the buffer number of the mark.
3862 "lnum" and "col" are the position in the buffer. The first
3863 column is 1.
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00003864 The "off" number is zero, unless 'virtualedit' is used. Then
3865 it is the offset in screen columns from the start of the
Bram Moolenaard46bbc72007-05-12 14:38:41 +00003866 character. E.g., a position within a <Tab> or after the last
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00003867 character.
3868 This can be used to save and restore the cursor position: >
3869 let save_cursor = getpos(".")
3870 MoveTheCursorAround
Bram Moolenaardb552d602006-03-23 22:59:57 +00003871 call setpos('.', save_cursor)
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00003872< Also see |setpos()|.
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00003873
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00003874pathshorten({expr}) *pathshorten()*
3875 Shorten directory names in the path {expr} and return the
3876 result. The tail, the file name, is kept as-is. The other
3877 components in the path are reduced to single letters. Leading
3878 '~' and '.' characters are kept. Example: >
3879 :echo pathshorten('~/.vim/autoload/myfile.vim')
3880< ~/.v/a/myfile.vim ~
3881 It doesn't matter if the path exists or not.
3882
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00003883prevnonblank({lnum}) *prevnonblank()*
3884 Return the line number of the first line at or above {lnum}
3885 that is not blank. Example: >
3886 let ind = indent(prevnonblank(v:lnum - 1))
3887< When {lnum} is invalid or there is no non-blank line at or
3888 above it, zero is returned.
3889 Also see |nextnonblank()|.
3890
3891
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003892printf({fmt}, {expr1} ...) *printf()*
3893 Return a String with {fmt}, where "%" items are replaced by
3894 the formatted form of their respective arguments. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003895 printf("%4d: E%d %.30s", lnum, errno, msg)
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003896< May result in:
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003897 " 99: E42 asdfasdfasdfasdfasdfasdfasdfas" ~
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003898
3899 Often used items are:
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00003900 %s string
Bram Moolenaar98692072006-02-04 00:57:42 +00003901 %6s string right-aligned in 6 bytes
3902 %.9s string truncated to 9 bytes
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003903 %c single byte
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003904 %d decimal number
3905 %5d decimal number padded with spaces to 5 characters
3906 %x hex number
3907 %04x hex number padded with zeros to at least 4 characters
3908 %X hex number using upper case letters
3909 %o octal number
Bram Moolenaar98692072006-02-04 00:57:42 +00003910 %% the % character itself
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003911
3912 Conversion specifications start with '%' and end with the
3913 conversion type. All other characters are copied unchanged to
3914 the result.
3915
3916 The "%" starts a conversion specification. The following
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003917 arguments appear in sequence:
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003918
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003919 % [flags] [field-width] [.precision] type
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003920
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00003921 flags
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003922 Zero or more of the following flags:
3923
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003924 # The value should be converted to an "alternate
3925 form". For c, d, and s conversions, this option
3926 has no effect. For o conversions, the precision
3927 of the number is increased to force the first
3928 character of the output string to a zero (except
3929 if a zero value is printed with an explicit
3930 precision of zero).
3931 For x and X conversions, a non-zero result has
3932 the string "0x" (or "0X" for X conversions)
3933 prepended to it.
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003934
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003935 0 (zero) Zero padding. For all conversions the converted
3936 value is padded on the left with zeros rather
3937 than blanks. If a precision is given with a
3938 numeric conversion (d, o, x, and X), the 0 flag
3939 is ignored.
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003940
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003941 - A negative field width flag; the converted value
3942 is to be left adjusted on the field boundary.
3943 The converted value is padded on the right with
3944 blanks, rather than on the left with blanks or
3945 zeros. A - overrides a 0 if both are given.
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003946
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003947 ' ' (space) A blank should be left before a positive
3948 number produced by a signed conversion (d).
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003949
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003950 + A sign must always be placed before a number
3951 produced by a signed conversion. A + overrides
3952 a space if both are used.
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003953
3954 field-width
3955 An optional decimal digit string specifying a minimum
Bram Moolenaar98692072006-02-04 00:57:42 +00003956 field width. If the converted value has fewer bytes
3957 than the field width, it will be padded with spaces on
3958 the left (or right, if the left-adjustment flag has
3959 been given) to fill out the field width.
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003960
3961 .precision
3962 An optional precision, in the form of a period '.'
3963 followed by an optional digit string. If the digit
3964 string is omitted, the precision is taken as zero.
3965 This gives the minimum number of digits to appear for
3966 d, o, x, and X conversions, or the maximum number of
Bram Moolenaar98692072006-02-04 00:57:42 +00003967 bytes to be printed from a string for s conversions.
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003968
3969 type
3970 A character that specifies the type of conversion to
3971 be applied, see below.
3972
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003973 A field width or precision, or both, may be indicated by an
3974 asterisk '*' instead of a digit string. In this case, a
3975 Number argument supplies the field width or precision. A
3976 negative field width is treated as a left adjustment flag
3977 followed by a positive field width; a negative precision is
3978 treated as though it were missing. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003979 :echo printf("%d: %.*s", nr, width, line)
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003980< This limits the length of the text used from "line" to
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003981 "width" bytes.
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003982
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00003983 The conversion specifiers and their meanings are:
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003984
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00003985 doxX The Number argument is converted to signed decimal
3986 (d), unsigned octal (o), or unsigned hexadecimal (x
3987 and X) notation. The letters "abcdef" are used for
3988 x conversions; the letters "ABCDEF" are used for X
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00003989 conversions.
3990 The precision, if any, gives the minimum number of
3991 digits that must appear; if the converted value
3992 requires fewer digits, it is padded on the left with
3993 zeros.
3994 In no case does a non-existent or small field width
3995 cause truncation of a numeric field; if the result of
3996 a conversion is wider than the field width, the field
3997 is expanded to contain the conversion result.
3998
3999 c The Number argument is converted to a byte, and the
4000 resulting character is written.
4001
4002 s The text of the String argument is used. If a
4003 precision is specified, no more bytes than the number
4004 specified are used.
4005
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00004006 % A '%' is written. No argument is converted. The
4007 complete conversion specification is "%%".
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00004008
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00004009 Each argument can be Number or String and is converted
4010 automatically to fit the conversion specifier. Any other
4011 argument type results in an error message.
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00004012
Bram Moolenaar83bab712005-08-01 21:58:57 +00004013 *E766* *E767*
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00004014 The number of {exprN} arguments must exactly match the number
4015 of "%" items. If there are not sufficient or too many
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00004016 arguments an error is given. Up to 18 arguments can be used.
Bram Moolenaar4be06f92005-07-29 22:36:03 +00004017
4018
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00004019pumvisible() *pumvisible()*
4020 Returns non-zero when the popup menu is visible, zero
4021 otherwise. See |ins-completion-menu|.
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00004022 This can be used to avoid some things that would remove the
4023 popup menu.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004024
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00004025 *E726* *E727*
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00004026range({expr} [, {max} [, {stride}]]) *range()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00004027 Returns a |List| with Numbers:
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00004028 - If only {expr} is specified: [0, 1, ..., {expr} - 1]
4029 - If {max} is specified: [{expr}, {expr} + 1, ..., {max}]
4030 - If {stride} is specified: [{expr}, {expr} + {stride}, ...,
4031 {max}] (increasing {expr} with {stride} each time, not
4032 producing a value past {max}).
Bram Moolenaare7566042005-06-17 22:00:15 +00004033 When the maximum is one before the start the result is an
4034 empty list. When the maximum is more than one before the
4035 start this is an error.
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00004036 Examples: >
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00004037 range(4) " [0, 1, 2, 3]
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00004038 range(2, 4) " [2, 3, 4]
4039 range(2, 9, 3) " [2, 5, 8]
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00004040 range(2, -2, -1) " [2, 1, 0, -1, -2]
Bram Moolenaare7566042005-06-17 22:00:15 +00004041 range(0) " []
4042 range(2, 0) " error!
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00004043<
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00004044 *readfile()*
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00004045readfile({fname} [, {binary} [, {max}]])
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00004046 Read file {fname} and return a |List|, each line of the file
4047 as an item. Lines broken at NL characters. Macintosh files
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00004048 separated with CR will result in a single long line (unless a
4049 NL appears somewhere).
4050 When {binary} is equal to "b" binary mode is used:
4051 - When the last line ends in a NL an extra empty list item is
4052 added.
4053 - No CR characters are removed.
4054 Otherwise:
4055 - CR characters that appear before a NL are removed.
4056 - Whether the last line ends in a NL or not does not matter.
4057 All NUL characters are replaced with a NL character.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00004058 When {max} is given this specifies the maximum number of lines
4059 to be read. Useful if you only want to check the first ten
4060 lines of a file: >
4061 :for line in readfile(fname, '', 10)
4062 : if line =~ 'Date' | echo line | endif
4063 :endfor
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004064< When {max} is negative -{max} lines from the end of the file
4065 are returned, or as many as there are.
4066 When {max} is zero the result is an empty list.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00004067 Note that without {max} the whole file is read into memory.
4068 Also note that there is no recognition of encoding. Read a
4069 file into a buffer if you need to.
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00004070 When the file can't be opened an error message is given and
4071 the result is an empty list.
4072 Also see |writefile()|.
4073
Bram Moolenaar433f7c82006-03-21 21:29:36 +00004074reltime([{start} [, {end}]]) *reltime()*
4075 Return an item that represents a time value. The format of
4076 the item depends on the system. It can be passed to
4077 |reltimestr()| to convert it to a string.
4078 Without an argument it returns the current time.
4079 With one argument is returns the time passed since the time
4080 specified in the argument.
Bram Moolenaar551dbcc2006-04-25 22:13:59 +00004081 With two arguments it returns the time passed between {start}
Bram Moolenaar433f7c82006-03-21 21:29:36 +00004082 and {end}.
4083 The {start} and {end} arguments must be values returned by
4084 reltime().
4085 {only available when compiled with the +reltime feature}
4086
4087reltimestr({time}) *reltimestr()*
4088 Return a String that represents the time value of {time}.
4089 This is the number of seconds, a dot and the number of
4090 microseconds. Example: >
4091 let start = reltime()
4092 call MyFunction()
4093 echo reltimestr(reltime(start))
4094< Note that overhead for the commands will be added to the time.
4095 The accuracy depends on the system.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00004096 Leading spaces are used to make the string align nicely. You
4097 can use split() to remove it. >
4098 echo split(reltimestr(reltime(start)))[0]
4099< Also see |profiling|.
Bram Moolenaar433f7c82006-03-21 21:29:36 +00004100 {only available when compiled with the +reltime feature}
4101
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004102 *remote_expr()* *E449*
4103remote_expr({server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
4104 Send the {string} to {server}. The string is sent as an
4105 expression and the result is returned after evaluation.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00004106 The result must be a String or a |List|. A |List| is turned
4107 into a String by joining the items with a line break in
4108 between (not at the end), like with join(expr, "\n").
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004109 If {idvar} is present, it is taken as the name of a
4110 variable and a {serverid} for later use with
4111 remote_read() is stored there.
4112 See also |clientserver| |RemoteReply|.
4113 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
4114 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
4115 Note: Any errors will cause a local error message to be issued
4116 and the result will be the empty string.
4117 Examples: >
4118 :echo remote_expr("gvim", "2+2")
4119 :echo remote_expr("gvim1", "b:current_syntax")
4120<
4121
4122remote_foreground({server}) *remote_foreground()*
4123 Move the Vim server with the name {server} to the foreground.
4124 This works like: >
4125 remote_expr({server}, "foreground()")
4126< Except that on Win32 systems the client does the work, to work
4127 around the problem that the OS doesn't always allow the server
4128 to bring itself to the foreground.
Bram Moolenaar9372a112005-12-06 19:59:18 +00004129 Note: This does not restore the window if it was minimized,
4130 like foreground() does.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004131 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
4132 {only in the Win32, Athena, Motif and GTK GUI versions and the
4133 Win32 console version}
4134
4135
4136remote_peek({serverid} [, {retvar}]) *remote_peek()*
4137 Returns a positive number if there are available strings
4138 from {serverid}. Copies any reply string into the variable
4139 {retvar} if specified. {retvar} must be a string with the
4140 name of a variable.
4141 Returns zero if none are available.
4142 Returns -1 if something is wrong.
4143 See also |clientserver|.
4144 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
4145 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
4146 Examples: >
4147 :let repl = ""
4148 :echo "PEEK: ".remote_peek(id, "repl").": ".repl
4149
4150remote_read({serverid}) *remote_read()*
4151 Return the oldest available reply from {serverid} and consume
4152 it. It blocks until a reply is available.
4153 See also |clientserver|.
4154 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
4155 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
4156 Example: >
4157 :echo remote_read(id)
4158<
4159 *remote_send()* *E241*
4160remote_send({server}, {string} [, {idvar}])
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +00004161 Send the {string} to {server}. The string is sent as input
4162 keys and the function returns immediately. At the Vim server
4163 the keys are not mapped |:map|.
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00004164 If {idvar} is present, it is taken as the name of a variable
4165 and a {serverid} for later use with remote_read() is stored
4166 there.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004167 See also |clientserver| |RemoteReply|.
4168 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
4169 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
4170 Note: Any errors will be reported in the server and may mess
4171 up the display.
4172 Examples: >
4173 :echo remote_send("gvim", ":DropAndReply ".file, "serverid").
4174 \ remote_read(serverid)
4175
4176 :autocmd NONE RemoteReply *
4177 \ echo remote_read(expand("<amatch>"))
4178 :echo remote_send("gvim", ":sleep 10 | echo ".
4179 \ 'server2client(expand("<client>"), "HELLO")<CR>')
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004180<
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00004181remove({list}, {idx} [, {end}]) *remove()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00004182 Without {end}: Remove the item at {idx} from |List| {list} and
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00004183 return it.
4184 With {end}: Remove items from {idx} to {end} (inclusive) and
4185 return a list with these items. When {idx} points to the same
4186 item as {end} a list with one item is returned. When {end}
4187 points to an item before {idx} this is an error.
4188 See |list-index| for possible values of {idx} and {end}.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00004189 Example: >
4190 :echo "last item: " . remove(mylist, -1)
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00004191 :call remove(mylist, 0, 9)
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00004192remove({dict}, {key})
4193 Remove the entry from {dict} with key {key}. Example: >
4194 :echo "removed " . remove(dict, "one")
4195< If there is no {key} in {dict} this is an error.
4196
4197 Use |delete()| to remove a file.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00004198
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004199rename({from}, {to}) *rename()*
4200 Rename the file by the name {from} to the name {to}. This
4201 should also work to move files across file systems. The
4202 result is a Number, which is 0 if the file was renamed
4203 successfully, and non-zero when the renaming failed.
4204 This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
4205
Bram Moolenaarab79bcb2004-07-18 21:34:53 +00004206repeat({expr}, {count}) *repeat()*
4207 Repeat {expr} {count} times and return the concatenated
4208 result. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar551dbcc2006-04-25 22:13:59 +00004209 :let separator = repeat('-', 80)
Bram Moolenaarab79bcb2004-07-18 21:34:53 +00004210< When {count} is zero or negative the result is empty.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00004211 When {expr} is a |List| the result is {expr} concatenated
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00004212 {count} times. Example: >
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00004213 :let longlist = repeat(['a', 'b'], 3)
4214< Results in ['a', 'b', 'a', 'b', 'a', 'b'].
Bram Moolenaarab79bcb2004-07-18 21:34:53 +00004215
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004216
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004217resolve({filename}) *resolve()* *E655*
4218 On MS-Windows, when {filename} is a shortcut (a .lnk file),
4219 returns the path the shortcut points to in a simplified form.
4220 On Unix, repeat resolving symbolic links in all path
4221 components of {filename} and return the simplified result.
4222 To cope with link cycles, resolving of symbolic links is
4223 stopped after 100 iterations.
4224 On other systems, return the simplified {filename}.
4225 The simplification step is done as by |simplify()|.
4226 resolve() keeps a leading path component specifying the
4227 current directory (provided the result is still a relative
4228 path name) and also keeps a trailing path separator.
4229
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004230 *reverse()*
4231reverse({list}) Reverse the order of items in {list} in-place. Returns
4232 {list}.
4233 If you want a list to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
4234 :let revlist = reverse(copy(mylist))
4235
Bram Moolenaar76929292008-01-06 19:07:36 +00004236search({pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]) *search()*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004237 Search for regexp pattern {pattern}. The search starts at the
Bram Moolenaar383f9bc2005-01-19 22:18:32 +00004238 cursor position (you can use |cursor()| to set it).
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00004239
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004240 {flags} is a String, which can contain these character flags:
4241 'b' search backward instead of forward
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00004242 'c' accept a match at the cursor position
4243 'e' move to the End of the match
Bram Moolenaar5eb86f92004-07-26 12:53:41 +00004244 'n' do Not move the cursor
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00004245 'p' return number of matching sub-pattern (see below)
4246 's' set the ' mark at the previous location of the cursor
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004247 'w' wrap around the end of the file
4248 'W' don't wrap around the end of the file
4249 If neither 'w' or 'W' is given, the 'wrapscan' option applies.
4250
Bram Moolenaar02743632005-07-25 20:42:36 +00004251 If the 's' flag is supplied, the ' mark is set, only if the
4252 cursor is moved. The 's' flag cannot be combined with the 'n'
4253 flag.
4254
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00004255 'ignorecase', 'smartcase' and 'magic' are used.
4256
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004257 When the {stopline} argument is given then the search stops
4258 after searching this line. This is useful to restrict the
4259 search to a range of lines. Examples: >
4260 let match = search('(', 'b', line("w0"))
4261 let end = search('END', '', line("w$"))
4262< When {stopline} is used and it is not zero this also implies
4263 that the search does not wrap around the end of the file.
Bram Moolenaar76929292008-01-06 19:07:36 +00004264 A zero value is equal to not giving the argument.
4265
4266 When the {timeout} argument is given the search stops when
4267 more than this many milli seconds have passed. Thus when
4268 {timeout} is 500 the search stops after half a second.
4269 The value must not be negative. A zero value is like not
4270 giving the argument.
4271 {only available when compiled with the +reltime feature}
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004272
Bram Moolenaar5eb86f92004-07-26 12:53:41 +00004273 If there is no match a 0 is returned and the cursor doesn't
4274 move. No error message is given.
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00004275 When a match has been found its line number is returned.
4276 *search()-sub-match*
4277 With the 'p' flag the returned value is one more than the
4278 first sub-match in \(\). One if none of them matched but the
4279 whole pattern did match.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004280 To get the column number too use |searchpos()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004281
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00004282 The cursor will be positioned at the match, unless the 'n'
4283 flag is used.
4284
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004285 Example (goes over all files in the argument list): >
4286 :let n = 1
4287 :while n <= argc() " loop over all files in arglist
4288 : exe "argument " . n
4289 : " start at the last char in the file and wrap for the
4290 : " first search to find match at start of file
4291 : normal G$
4292 : let flags = "w"
4293 : while search("foo", flags) > 0
4294 : s/foo/bar/g
4295 : let flags = "W"
4296 : endwhile
4297 : update " write the file if modified
4298 : let n = n + 1
4299 :endwhile
4300<
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00004301 Example for using some flags: >
4302 :echo search('\<if\|\(else\)\|\(endif\)', 'ncpe')
4303< This will search for the keywords "if", "else", and "endif"
4304 under or after the cursor. Because of the 'p' flag, it
4305 returns 1, 2, or 3 depending on which keyword is found, or 0
4306 if the search fails. With the cursor on the first word of the
4307 line:
4308 if (foo == 0) | let foo = foo + 1 | endif ~
4309 the function returns 1. Without the 'c' flag, the function
4310 finds the "endif" and returns 3. The same thing happens
4311 without the 'e' flag if the cursor is on the "f" of "if".
4312 The 'n' flag tells the function not to move the cursor.
4313
Bram Moolenaar92d640f2005-09-05 22:11:52 +00004314
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +00004315searchdecl({name} [, {global} [, {thisblock}]]) *searchdecl()*
4316 Search for the declaration of {name}.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00004317
Bram Moolenaarf75a9632005-09-13 21:20:47 +00004318 With a non-zero {global} argument it works like |gD|, find
4319 first match in the file. Otherwise it works like |gd|, find
4320 first match in the function.
4321
4322 With a non-zero {thisblock} argument matches in a {} block
4323 that ends before the cursor position are ignored. Avoids
4324 finding variable declarations only valid in another scope.
4325
Bram Moolenaar92d640f2005-09-05 22:11:52 +00004326 Moves the cursor to the found match.
4327 Returns zero for success, non-zero for failure.
4328 Example: >
4329 if searchdecl('myvar') == 0
4330 echo getline('.')
4331 endif
4332<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004333 *searchpair()*
Bram Moolenaar76929292008-01-06 19:07:36 +00004334searchpair({start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip}
4335 [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]])
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004336 Search for the match of a nested start-end pair. This can be
4337 used to find the "endif" that matches an "if", while other
4338 if/endif pairs in between are ignored.
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00004339 The search starts at the cursor. The default is to search
4340 forward, include 'b' in {flags} to search backward.
4341 If a match is found, the cursor is positioned at it and the
4342 line number is returned. If no match is found 0 or -1 is
4343 returned and the cursor doesn't move. No error message is
4344 given.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004345
4346 {start}, {middle} and {end} are patterns, see |pattern|. They
4347 must not contain \( \) pairs. Use of \%( \) is allowed. When
4348 {middle} is not empty, it is found when searching from either
4349 direction, but only when not in a nested start-end pair. A
4350 typical use is: >
4351 searchpair('\<if\>', '\<else\>', '\<endif\>')
4352< By leaving {middle} empty the "else" is skipped.
4353
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00004354 {flags} 'b', 'c', 'n', 's', 'w' and 'W' are used like with
4355 |search()|. Additionally:
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004356 'r' Repeat until no more matches found; will find the
4357 outer pair
4358 'm' return number of Matches instead of line number with
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00004359 the match; will be > 1 when 'r' is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004360
4361 When a match for {start}, {middle} or {end} is found, the
4362 {skip} expression is evaluated with the cursor positioned on
4363 the start of the match. It should return non-zero if this
4364 match is to be skipped. E.g., because it is inside a comment
4365 or a string.
4366 When {skip} is omitted or empty, every match is accepted.
4367 When evaluating {skip} causes an error the search is aborted
4368 and -1 returned.
4369
Bram Moolenaar76929292008-01-06 19:07:36 +00004370 For {stopline} and {timeout} see |search()|.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004371
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004372 The value of 'ignorecase' is used. 'magic' is ignored, the
4373 patterns are used like it's on.
4374
4375 The search starts exactly at the cursor. A match with
4376 {start}, {middle} or {end} at the next character, in the
4377 direction of searching, is the first one found. Example: >
4378 if 1
4379 if 2
4380 endif 2
4381 endif 1
4382< When starting at the "if 2", with the cursor on the "i", and
4383 searching forwards, the "endif 2" is found. When starting on
4384 the character just before the "if 2", the "endif 1" will be
4385 found. That's because the "if 2" will be found first, and
4386 then this is considered to be a nested if/endif from "if 2" to
4387 "endif 2".
4388 When searching backwards and {end} is more than one character,
4389 it may be useful to put "\zs" at the end of the pattern, so
4390 that when the cursor is inside a match with the end it finds
4391 the matching start.
4392
4393 Example, to find the "endif" command in a Vim script: >
4394
4395 :echo searchpair('\<if\>', '\<el\%[seif]\>', '\<en\%[dif]\>', 'W',
4396 \ 'getline(".") =~ "^\\s*\""')
4397
4398< The cursor must be at or after the "if" for which a match is
4399 to be found. Note that single-quote strings are used to avoid
4400 having to double the backslashes. The skip expression only
4401 catches comments at the start of a line, not after a command.
4402 Also, a word "en" or "if" halfway a line is considered a
4403 match.
4404 Another example, to search for the matching "{" of a "}": >
4405
4406 :echo searchpair('{', '', '}', 'bW')
4407
4408< This works when the cursor is at or before the "}" for which a
4409 match is to be found. To reject matches that syntax
4410 highlighting recognized as strings: >
4411
4412 :echo searchpair('{', '', '}', 'bW',
4413 \ 'synIDattr(synID(line("."), col("."), 0), "name") =~? "string"')
4414<
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00004415 *searchpairpos()*
Bram Moolenaar76929292008-01-06 19:07:36 +00004416searchpairpos({start}, {middle}, {end} [, {flags} [, {skip}
4417 [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]])
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00004418 Same as searchpair(), but returns a |List| with the line and
4419 column position of the match. The first element of the |List|
4420 is the line number and the second element is the byte index of
Bram Moolenaar1d2ba7f2006-02-14 22:29:30 +00004421 the column position of the match. If no match is found,
4422 returns [0, 0].
4423>
4424 :let [lnum,col] = searchpairpos('{', '', '}', 'n')
4425<
4426 See |match-parens| for a bigger and more useful example.
4427
Bram Moolenaar76929292008-01-06 19:07:36 +00004428searchpos({pattern} [, {flags} [, {stopline} [, {timeout}]]]) *searchpos()*
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004429 Same as |search()|, but returns a |List| with the line and
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00004430 column position of the match. The first element of the |List|
4431 is the line number and the second element is the byte index of
4432 the column position of the match. If no match is found,
4433 returns [0, 0].
Bram Moolenaar362e1a32006-03-06 23:29:24 +00004434 Example: >
4435 :let [lnum, col] = searchpos('mypattern', 'n')
4436
4437< When the 'p' flag is given then there is an extra item with
4438 the sub-pattern match number |search()-sub-match|. Example: >
4439 :let [lnum, col, submatch] = searchpos('\(\l\)\|\(\u\)', 'np')
4440< In this example "submatch" is 2 when a lowercase letter is
4441 found |/\l|, 3 when an uppercase letter is found |/\u|.
4442
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004443server2client( {clientid}, {string}) *server2client()*
4444 Send a reply string to {clientid}. The most recent {clientid}
4445 that sent a string can be retrieved with expand("<client>").
4446 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
4447 Note:
4448 This id has to be stored before the next command can be
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00004449 received. I.e. before returning from the received command and
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004450 before calling any commands that waits for input.
4451 See also |clientserver|.
4452 Example: >
4453 :echo server2client(expand("<client>"), "HELLO")
4454<
4455serverlist() *serverlist()*
4456 Return a list of available server names, one per line.
4457 When there are no servers or the information is not available
4458 an empty string is returned. See also |clientserver|.
4459 {only available when compiled with the |+clientserver| feature}
4460 Example: >
4461 :echo serverlist()
4462<
4463setbufvar({expr}, {varname}, {val}) *setbufvar()*
4464 Set option or local variable {varname} in buffer {expr} to
4465 {val}.
4466 This also works for a global or local window option, but it
4467 doesn't work for a global or local window variable.
4468 For a local window option the global value is unchanged.
4469 For the use of {expr}, see |bufname()| above.
4470 Note that the variable name without "b:" must be used.
4471 Examples: >
4472 :call setbufvar(1, "&mod", 1)
4473 :call setbufvar("todo", "myvar", "foobar")
4474< This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
4475
4476setcmdpos({pos}) *setcmdpos()*
4477 Set the cursor position in the command line to byte position
4478 {pos}. The first position is 1.
4479 Use |getcmdpos()| to obtain the current position.
4480 Only works while editing the command line, thus you must use
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00004481 |c_CTRL-\_e|, |c_CTRL-R_=| or |c_CTRL-R_CTRL-R| with '='. For
4482 |c_CTRL-\_e| and |c_CTRL-R_CTRL-R| with '=' the position is
4483 set after the command line is set to the expression. For
4484 |c_CTRL-R_=| it is set after evaluating the expression but
4485 before inserting the resulting text.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004486 When the number is too big the cursor is put at the end of the
4487 line. A number smaller than one has undefined results.
4488 Returns 0 when successful, 1 when not editing the command
4489 line.
4490
4491setline({lnum}, {line}) *setline()*
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00004492 Set line {lnum} of the current buffer to {line}.
4493 {lnum} is used like with |getline()|.
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00004494 When {lnum} is just below the last line the {line} will be
4495 added as a new line.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00004496 If this succeeds, 0 is returned. If this fails (most likely
4497 because {lnum} is invalid) 1 is returned. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004498 :call setline(5, strftime("%c"))
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00004499< When {line} is a |List| then line {lnum} and following lines
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00004500 will be set to the items in the list. Example: >
4501 :call setline(5, ['aaa', 'bbb', 'ccc'])
4502< This is equivalent to: >
4503 :for [n, l] in [[5, 6, 7], ['aaa', 'bbb', 'ccc']]
4504 : call setline(n, l)
4505 :endfor
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004506< Note: The '[ and '] marks are not set.
4507
Bram Moolenaar17c7c012006-01-26 22:25:15 +00004508setloclist({nr}, {list} [, {action}]) *setloclist()*
4509 Create or replace or add to the location list for window {nr}.
4510 When {nr} is zero the current window is used. For a location
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00004511 list window, the displayed location list is modified. For an
4512 invalid window number {nr}, -1 is returned.
Bram Moolenaar6ee10162007-07-26 20:58:42 +00004513 Otherwise, same as |setqflist()|.
4514 Also see |location-list|.
4515
4516setmatches({list}) *setmatches()*
4517 Restores a list of matches saved by |getmatches()|. Returns 0
4518 if succesfull, otherwise -1. All current matches are cleared
4519 before the list is restored. See example for |getmatches()|.
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00004520
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00004521 *setpos()*
4522setpos({expr}, {list})
4523 Set the position for {expr}. Possible values:
4524 . the cursor
4525 'x mark x
4526
4527 {list} must be a |List| with four numbers:
4528 [bufnum, lnum, col, off]
4529
4530 "bufnum" is the buffer number. Zero can be used for the
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00004531 current buffer. Setting the cursor is only possible for
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00004532 the current buffer. To set a mark in another buffer you can
4533 use the |bufnr()| function to turn a file name into a buffer
4534 number.
Bram Moolenaardb552d602006-03-23 22:59:57 +00004535 Does not change the jumplist.
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00004536
4537 "lnum" and "col" are the position in the buffer. The first
4538 column is 1. Use a zero "lnum" to delete a mark.
4539
4540 The "off" number is only used when 'virtualedit' is set. Then
4541 it is the offset in screen columns from the start of the
Bram Moolenaard46bbc72007-05-12 14:38:41 +00004542 character. E.g., a position within a <Tab> or after the last
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00004543 character.
4544
Bram Moolenaar08250432008-02-13 11:42:46 +00004545 Returns 0 when the position could be set, -1 otherwise.
4546 An error message is given if {expr} is invalid.
4547
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00004548 Also see |getpos()|
4549
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00004550 This does not restore the preferred column for moving
4551 vertically. See |winrestview()| for that.
4552
Bram Moolenaar65c923a2006-03-03 22:56:30 +00004553
Bram Moolenaar35c54e52005-05-20 21:25:31 +00004554setqflist({list} [, {action}]) *setqflist()*
Bram Moolenaar17c7c012006-01-26 22:25:15 +00004555 Create or replace or add to the quickfix list using the items
4556 in {list}. Each item in {list} is a dictionary.
4557 Non-dictionary items in {list} are ignored. Each dictionary
4558 item can contain the following entries:
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00004559
Bram Moolenaar48b66fb2007-02-04 01:58:18 +00004560 bufnr buffer number; must be the number of a valid
4561 buffer
4562 filename name of a file; only used when "bufnr" is not
4563 present or it is invalid.
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00004564 lnum line number in the file
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00004565 pattern search pattern used to locate the error
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004566 col column number
4567 vcol when non-zero: "col" is visual column
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00004568 when zero: "col" is byte index
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004569 nr error number
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00004570 text description of the error
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004571 type single-character error type, 'E', 'W', etc.
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00004572
Bram Moolenaar582fd852005-03-28 20:58:01 +00004573 The "col", "vcol", "nr", "type" and "text" entries are
4574 optional. Either "lnum" or "pattern" entry can be used to
4575 locate a matching error line.
Bram Moolenaar48b66fb2007-02-04 01:58:18 +00004576 If the "filename" and "bufnr" entries are not present or
4577 neither the "lnum" or "pattern" entries are present, then the
4578 item will not be handled as an error line.
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00004579 If both "pattern" and "lnum" are present then "pattern" will
4580 be used.
Bram Moolenaar48b66fb2007-02-04 01:58:18 +00004581 Note that the list is not exactly the same as what
4582 |getqflist()| returns.
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00004583
Bram Moolenaar35c54e52005-05-20 21:25:31 +00004584 If {action} is set to 'a', then the items from {list} are
4585 added to the existing quickfix list. If there is no existing
4586 list, then a new list is created. If {action} is set to 'r',
4587 then the items from the current quickfix list are replaced
4588 with the items from {list}. If {action} is not present or is
4589 set to ' ', then a new list is created.
4590
Bram Moolenaar68b76a62005-03-25 21:53:48 +00004591 Returns zero for success, -1 for failure.
4592
4593 This function can be used to create a quickfix list
4594 independent of the 'errorformat' setting. Use a command like
4595 ":cc 1" to jump to the first position.
4596
4597
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004598 *setreg()*
4599setreg({regname}, {value} [,{options}])
4600 Set the register {regname} to {value}.
4601 If {options} contains "a" or {regname} is upper case,
4602 then the value is appended.
4603 {options} can also contains a register type specification:
4604 "c" or "v" |characterwise| mode
4605 "l" or "V" |linewise| mode
4606 "b" or "<CTRL-V>" |blockwise-visual| mode
4607 If a number immediately follows "b" or "<CTRL-V>" then this is
4608 used as the width of the selection - if it is not specified
4609 then the width of the block is set to the number of characters
Bram Moolenaard46bbc72007-05-12 14:38:41 +00004610 in the longest line (counting a <Tab> as 1 character).
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004611
4612 If {options} contains no register settings, then the default
4613 is to use character mode unless {value} ends in a <NL>.
4614 Setting the '=' register is not possible.
4615 Returns zero for success, non-zero for failure.
4616
4617 Examples: >
4618 :call setreg(v:register, @*)
4619 :call setreg('*', @%, 'ac')
4620 :call setreg('a', "1\n2\n3", 'b5')
4621
4622< This example shows using the functions to save and restore a
4623 register. >
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00004624 :let var_a = getreg('a', 1)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004625 :let var_amode = getregtype('a')
4626 ....
4627 :call setreg('a', var_a, var_amode)
4628
4629< You can also change the type of a register by appending
4630 nothing: >
4631 :call setreg('a', '', 'al')
4632
Bram Moolenaarc6249bb2006-04-15 20:25:09 +00004633settabwinvar({tabnr}, {winnr}, {varname}, {val}) *settabwinvar()*
4634 Set option or local variable {varname} in window {winnr} to
4635 {val}.
4636 Tabs are numbered starting with one. For the current tabpage
4637 use |setwinvar()|.
4638 When {winnr} is zero the current window is used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004639 This also works for a global or local buffer option, but it
4640 doesn't work for a global or local buffer variable.
4641 For a local buffer option the global value is unchanged.
4642 Note that the variable name without "w:" must be used.
Bram Moolenaarc6249bb2006-04-15 20:25:09 +00004643 Vim briefly goes to the tab page {tabnr}, this may trigger
4644 TabLeave and TabEnter autocommands.
4645 Examples: >
4646 :call settabwinvar(1, 1, "&list", 0)
4647 :call settabwinvar(3, 2, "myvar", "foobar")
4648< This function is not available in the |sandbox|.
4649
4650setwinvar({nr}, {varname}, {val}) *setwinvar()*
4651 Like |settabwinvar()| for the current tab page.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004652 Examples: >
4653 :call setwinvar(1, "&list", 0)
4654 :call setwinvar(2, "myvar", "foobar")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004655
Bram Moolenaar60a495f2006-10-03 12:44:42 +00004656shellescape({string}) *shellescape()*
4657 Escape {string} for use as shell command argument.
4658 On MS-Windows and MS-DOS, when 'shellslash' is not set, it
4659 will enclose {string} double quotes and double all double
4660 quotes within {string}.
4661 For other systems, it will enclose {string} in single quotes
4662 and replace all "'" with "'\''".
4663 Example: >
4664 :echo shellescape('c:\program files\vim')
4665< results in:
4666 "c:\program files\vim" ~
4667 Example usage: >
4668 :call system("chmod +x -- " . shellescape(expand("%")))
4669
4670
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004671simplify({filename}) *simplify()*
4672 Simplify the file name as much as possible without changing
4673 the meaning. Shortcuts (on MS-Windows) or symbolic links (on
4674 Unix) are not resolved. If the first path component in
4675 {filename} designates the current directory, this will be
4676 valid for the result as well. A trailing path separator is
4677 not removed either.
4678 Example: >
4679 simplify("./dir/.././/file/") == "./file/"
4680< Note: The combination "dir/.." is only removed if "dir" is
4681 a searchable directory or does not exist. On Unix, it is also
4682 removed when "dir" is a symbolic link within the same
4683 directory. In order to resolve all the involved symbolic
4684 links before simplifying the path name, use |resolve()|.
4685
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004686
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +00004687sort({list} [, {func}]) *sort()* *E702*
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004688 Sort the items in {list} in-place. Returns {list}. If you
4689 want a list to remain unmodified make a copy first: >
4690 :let sortedlist = sort(copy(mylist))
4691< Uses the string representation of each item to sort on.
Bram Moolenaara23ccb82006-02-27 00:08:02 +00004692 Numbers sort after Strings, |Lists| after Numbers.
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00004693 For sorting text in the current buffer use |:sort|.
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004694 When {func} is given and it is one then case is ignored.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00004695 When {func} is a |Funcref| or a function name, this function
4696 is called to compare items. The function is invoked with two
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004697 items as argument and must return zero if they are equal, 1 if
4698 the first one sorts after the second one, -1 if the first one
4699 sorts before the second one. Example: >
4700 func MyCompare(i1, i2)
4701 return a:i1 == a:i2 ? 0 : a:i1 > a:i2 ? 1 : -1
4702 endfunc
4703 let sortedlist = sort(mylist, "MyCompare")
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00004704<
4705
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00004706 *soundfold()*
4707soundfold({word})
4708 Return the sound-folded equivalent of {word}. Uses the first
4709 language in 'spellang' for the current window that supports
Bram Moolenaar42eeac32005-06-29 22:40:58 +00004710 soundfolding. 'spell' must be set. When no sound folding is
4711 possible the {word} is returned unmodified.
Bram Moolenaar24bbcfe2005-06-28 23:32:02 +00004712 This can be used for making spelling suggestions. Note that
4713 the method can be quite slow.
4714
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00004715 *spellbadword()*
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004716spellbadword([{sentence}])
4717 Without argument: The result is the badly spelled word under
4718 or after the cursor. The cursor is moved to the start of the
4719 bad word. When no bad word is found in the cursor line the
4720 result is an empty string and the cursor doesn't move.
4721
4722 With argument: The result is the first word in {sentence} that
4723 is badly spelled. If there are no spelling mistakes the
4724 result is an empty string.
4725
4726 The return value is a list with two items:
4727 - The badly spelled word or an empty string.
4728 - The type of the spelling error:
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00004729 "bad" spelling mistake
Bram Moolenaar1e015462005-09-25 22:16:38 +00004730 "rare" rare word
4731 "local" word only valid in another region
4732 "caps" word should start with Capital
4733 Example: >
4734 echo spellbadword("the quik brown fox")
4735< ['quik', 'bad'] ~
4736
4737 The spelling information for the current window is used. The
4738 'spell' option must be set and the value of 'spelllang' is
4739 used.
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00004740
4741 *spellsuggest()*
Bram Moolenaarc54b8a72005-09-30 21:20:29 +00004742spellsuggest({word} [, {max} [, {capital}]])
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00004743 Return a |List| with spelling suggestions to replace {word}.
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00004744 When {max} is given up to this number of suggestions are
4745 returned. Otherwise up to 25 suggestions are returned.
4746
Bram Moolenaarc54b8a72005-09-30 21:20:29 +00004747 When the {capital} argument is given and it's non-zero only
4748 suggestions with a leading capital will be given. Use this
4749 after a match with 'spellcapcheck'.
4750
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00004751 {word} can be a badly spelled word followed by other text.
4752 This allows for joining two words that were split. The
Bram Moolenaarf461c8e2005-06-25 23:04:51 +00004753 suggestions also include the following text, thus you can
4754 replace a line.
4755
4756 {word} may also be a good word. Similar words will then be
Bram Moolenaarc54b8a72005-09-30 21:20:29 +00004757 returned. {word} itself is not included in the suggestions,
4758 although it may appear capitalized.
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00004759
4760 The spelling information for the current window is used. The
Bram Moolenaar42eeac32005-06-29 22:40:58 +00004761 'spell' option must be set and the values of 'spelllang' and
4762 'spellsuggest' are used.
Bram Moolenaard857f0e2005-06-21 22:37:39 +00004763
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004764
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00004765split({expr} [, {pattern} [, {keepempty}]]) *split()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00004766 Make a |List| out of {expr}. When {pattern} is omitted or
4767 empty each white-separated sequence of characters becomes an
4768 item.
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004769 Otherwise the string is split where {pattern} matches,
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00004770 removing the matched characters.
4771 When the first or last item is empty it is omitted, unless the
4772 {keepempty} argument is given and it's non-zero.
Bram Moolenaar5c06f8b2005-05-31 22:14:58 +00004773 Other empty items are kept when {pattern} matches at least one
4774 character or when {keepempty} is non-zero.
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004775 Example: >
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00004776 :let words = split(getline('.'), '\W\+')
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00004777< To split a string in individual characters: >
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00004778 :for c in split(mystring, '\zs')
Bram Moolenaar0cb032e2005-04-23 20:52:00 +00004779< If you want to keep the separator you can also use '\zs': >
4780 :echo split('abc:def:ghi', ':\zs')
4781< ['abc:', 'def:', 'ghi'] ~
Bram Moolenaar2389c3c2005-05-22 22:07:59 +00004782 Splitting a table where the first element can be empty: >
4783 :let items = split(line, ':', 1)
4784< The opposite function is |join()|.
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004785
4786
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00004787str2nr( {expr} [, {base}]) *str2nr()*
4788 Convert string {expr} to a number.
4789 {base} is the conversion base, it can be 8, 10 or 16.
4790 When {base} is omitted base 10 is used. This also means that
4791 a leading zero doesn't cause octal conversion to be used, as
4792 with the default String to Number conversion.
4793 When {base} is 16 a leading "0x" or "0X" is ignored. With a
4794 different base the result will be zero.
4795 Text after the number is silently ignored.
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00004796
Bram Moolenaar97b2ad32006-03-18 21:40:56 +00004797
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004798strftime({format} [, {time}]) *strftime()*
4799 The result is a String, which is a formatted date and time, as
4800 specified by the {format} string. The given {time} is used,
4801 or the current time if no time is given. The accepted
4802 {format} depends on your system, thus this is not portable!
4803 See the manual page of the C function strftime() for the
4804 format. The maximum length of the result is 80 characters.
4805 See also |localtime()| and |getftime()|.
4806 The language can be changed with the |:language| command.
4807 Examples: >
4808 :echo strftime("%c") Sun Apr 27 11:49:23 1997
4809 :echo strftime("%Y %b %d %X") 1997 Apr 27 11:53:25
4810 :echo strftime("%y%m%d %T") 970427 11:53:55
4811 :echo strftime("%H:%M") 11:55
4812 :echo strftime("%c", getftime("file.c"))
4813 Show mod time of file.c.
Bram Moolenaara14de3d2005-01-07 21:48:26 +00004814< Not available on all systems. To check use: >
4815 :if exists("*strftime")
4816
Bram Moolenaar8f999f12005-01-25 22:12:55 +00004817stridx({haystack}, {needle} [, {start}]) *stridx()*
4818 The result is a Number, which gives the byte index in
4819 {haystack} of the first occurrence of the String {needle}.
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00004820 If {start} is specified, the search starts at index {start}.
4821 This can be used to find a second match: >
4822 :let comma1 = stridx(line, ",")
4823 :let comma2 = stridx(line, ",", comma1 + 1)
4824< The search is done case-sensitive.
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00004825 For pattern searches use |match()|.
Bram Moolenaar8f999f12005-01-25 22:12:55 +00004826 -1 is returned if the {needle} does not occur in {haystack}.
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00004827 See also |strridx()|.
4828 Examples: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004829 :echo stridx("An Example", "Example") 3
4830 :echo stridx("Starting point", "Start") 0
4831 :echo stridx("Starting point", "start") -1
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00004832< *strstr()* *strchr()*
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00004833 stridx() works similar to the C function strstr(). When used
4834 with a single character it works similar to strchr().
4835
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00004836 *string()*
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00004837string({expr}) Return {expr} converted to a String. If {expr} is a Number,
4838 String or a composition of them, then the result can be parsed
4839 back with |eval()|.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00004840 {expr} type result ~
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00004841 String 'string'
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00004842 Number 123
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00004843 Funcref function('name')
Bram Moolenaar5f2bb9f2005-01-11 21:29:04 +00004844 List [item, item]
Bram Moolenaar9ba0eb82005-06-13 22:28:56 +00004845 Dictionary {key: value, key: value}
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00004846 Note that in String values the ' character is doubled.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00004847 Also see |strtrans()|.
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00004848
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004849 *strlen()*
4850strlen({expr}) The result is a Number, which is the length of the String
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00004851 {expr} in bytes.
4852 If you want to count the number of multi-byte characters (not
4853 counting composing characters) use something like this: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004854
4855 :let len = strlen(substitute(str, ".", "x", "g"))
Bram Moolenaare344bea2005-09-01 20:46:49 +00004856<
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00004857 If the argument is a Number it is first converted to a String.
4858 For other types an error is given.
4859 Also see |len()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004860
4861strpart({src}, {start}[, {len}]) *strpart()*
4862 The result is a String, which is part of {src}, starting from
Bram Moolenaar9372a112005-12-06 19:59:18 +00004863 byte {start}, with the byte length {len}.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004864 When non-existing bytes are included, this doesn't result in
4865 an error, the bytes are simply omitted.
4866 If {len} is missing, the copy continues from {start} till the
4867 end of the {src}. >
4868 strpart("abcdefg", 3, 2) == "de"
4869 strpart("abcdefg", -2, 4) == "ab"
4870 strpart("abcdefg", 5, 4) == "fg"
4871 strpart("abcdefg", 3) == "defg"
4872< Note: To get the first character, {start} must be 0. For
4873 example, to get three bytes under and after the cursor: >
Bram Moolenaar61660ea2006-04-07 21:40:07 +00004874 strpart(getline("."), col(".") - 1, 3)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004875<
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00004876strridx({haystack}, {needle} [, {start}]) *strridx()*
4877 The result is a Number, which gives the byte index in
4878 {haystack} of the last occurrence of the String {needle}.
4879 When {start} is specified, matches beyond this index are
4880 ignored. This can be used to find a match before a previous
4881 match: >
4882 :let lastcomma = strridx(line, ",")
4883 :let comma2 = strridx(line, ",", lastcomma - 1)
4884< The search is done case-sensitive.
Bram Moolenaar8f999f12005-01-25 22:12:55 +00004885 For pattern searches use |match()|.
4886 -1 is returned if the {needle} does not occur in {haystack}.
Bram Moolenaard4755bb2004-09-02 19:12:26 +00004887 If the {needle} is empty the length of {haystack} is returned.
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00004888 See also |stridx()|. Examples: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004889 :echo strridx("an angry armadillo", "an") 3
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00004890< *strrchr()*
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00004891 When used with a single character it works similar to the C
4892 function strrchr().
4893
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004894strtrans({expr}) *strtrans()*
4895 The result is a String, which is {expr} with all unprintable
4896 characters translated into printable characters |'isprint'|.
4897 Like they are shown in a window. Example: >
4898 echo strtrans(@a)
4899< This displays a newline in register a as "^@" instead of
4900 starting a new line.
4901
4902submatch({nr}) *submatch()*
4903 Only for an expression in a |:substitute| command. Returns
4904 the {nr}'th submatch of the matched text. When {nr} is 0
4905 the whole matched text is returned.
4906 Example: >
4907 :s/\d\+/\=submatch(0) + 1/
4908< This finds the first number in the line and adds one to it.
4909 A line break is included as a newline character.
4910
4911substitute({expr}, {pat}, {sub}, {flags}) *substitute()*
4912 The result is a String, which is a copy of {expr}, in which
4913 the first match of {pat} is replaced with {sub}. This works
4914 like the ":substitute" command (without any flags). But the
4915 matching with {pat} is always done like the 'magic' option is
4916 set and 'cpoptions' is empty (to make scripts portable).
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00004917 'ignorecase' is still relevant. 'smartcase' is not used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004918 See |string-match| for how {pat} is used.
4919 And a "~" in {sub} is not replaced with the previous {sub}.
4920 Note that some codes in {sub} have a special meaning
4921 |sub-replace-special|. For example, to replace something with
4922 "\n" (two characters), use "\\\\n" or '\\n'.
4923 When {pat} does not match in {expr}, {expr} is returned
4924 unmodified.
4925 When {flags} is "g", all matches of {pat} in {expr} are
4926 replaced. Otherwise {flags} should be "".
4927 Example: >
4928 :let &path = substitute(&path, ",\\=[^,]*$", "", "")
4929< This removes the last component of the 'path' option. >
4930 :echo substitute("testing", ".*", "\\U\\0", "")
4931< results in "TESTING".
4932
Bram Moolenaar47136d72004-10-12 20:02:24 +00004933synID({lnum}, {col}, {trans}) *synID()*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004934 The result is a Number, which is the syntax ID at the position
Bram Moolenaar47136d72004-10-12 20:02:24 +00004935 {lnum} and {col} in the current window.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004936 The syntax ID can be used with |synIDattr()| and
4937 |synIDtrans()| to obtain syntax information about text.
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00004938
Bram Moolenaar47136d72004-10-12 20:02:24 +00004939 {col} is 1 for the leftmost column, {lnum} is 1 for the first
Bram Moolenaarce0842a2005-07-18 21:58:11 +00004940 line. 'synmaxcol' applies, in a longer line zero is returned.
4941
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004942 When {trans} is non-zero, transparent items are reduced to the
4943 item that they reveal. This is useful when wanting to know
4944 the effective color. When {trans} is zero, the transparent
4945 item is returned. This is useful when wanting to know which
4946 syntax item is effective (e.g. inside parens).
4947 Warning: This function can be very slow. Best speed is
4948 obtained by going through the file in forward direction.
4949
4950 Example (echoes the name of the syntax item under the cursor): >
4951 :echo synIDattr(synID(line("."), col("."), 1), "name")
4952<
4953synIDattr({synID}, {what} [, {mode}]) *synIDattr()*
4954 The result is a String, which is the {what} attribute of
4955 syntax ID {synID}. This can be used to obtain information
4956 about a syntax item.
4957 {mode} can be "gui", "cterm" or "term", to get the attributes
4958 for that mode. When {mode} is omitted, or an invalid value is
4959 used, the attributes for the currently active highlighting are
4960 used (GUI, cterm or term).
4961 Use synIDtrans() to follow linked highlight groups.
4962 {what} result
4963 "name" the name of the syntax item
4964 "fg" foreground color (GUI: color name used to set
4965 the color, cterm: color number as a string,
4966 term: empty string)
4967 "bg" background color (like "fg")
4968 "fg#" like "fg", but for the GUI and the GUI is
4969 running the name in "#RRGGBB" form
4970 "bg#" like "fg#" for "bg"
4971 "bold" "1" if bold
4972 "italic" "1" if italic
4973 "reverse" "1" if reverse
4974 "inverse" "1" if inverse (= reverse)
4975 "underline" "1" if underlined
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00004976 "undercurl" "1" if undercurled
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00004977
4978 Example (echoes the color of the syntax item under the
4979 cursor): >
4980 :echo synIDattr(synIDtrans(synID(line("."), col("."), 1)), "fg")
4981<
4982synIDtrans({synID}) *synIDtrans()*
4983 The result is a Number, which is the translated syntax ID of
4984 {synID}. This is the syntax group ID of what is being used to
4985 highlight the character. Highlight links given with
4986 ":highlight link" are followed.
4987
Bram Moolenaar9d188ab2008-01-10 21:24:39 +00004988synstack({lnum}, {col}) *synstack()*
4989 Return a |List|, which is the stack of syntax items at the
4990 position {lnum} and {col} in the current window. Each item in
4991 the List is an ID like what |synID()| returns.
Bram Moolenaar9d188ab2008-01-10 21:24:39 +00004992 The first item in the List is the outer region, following are
4993 items contained in that one. The last one is what |synID()|
4994 returns, unless not the whole item is highlighted or it is a
4995 transparent item.
4996 This function is useful for debugging a syntax file.
4997 Example that shows the syntax stack under the cursor: >
4998 for id in synstack(line("."), col("."))
4999 echo synIDattr(id, "name")
5000 endfor
5001
Bram Moolenaarc0197e22004-09-13 20:26:32 +00005002system({expr} [, {input}]) *system()* *E677*
5003 Get the output of the shell command {expr}.
5004 When {input} is given, this string is written to a file and
5005 passed as stdin to the command. The string is written as-is,
5006 you need to take care of using the correct line separators
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00005007 yourself. Pipes are not used.
Bram Moolenaarc0197e22004-09-13 20:26:32 +00005008 Note: newlines in {expr} may cause the command to fail. The
5009 characters in 'shellquote' and 'shellxquote' may also cause
5010 trouble.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005011 This is not to be used for interactive commands.
5012 The result is a String. Example: >
5013
5014 :let files = system("ls")
5015
5016< To make the result more system-independent, the shell output
5017 is filtered to replace <CR> with <NL> for Macintosh, and
5018 <CR><NL> with <NL> for DOS-like systems.
5019 The command executed is constructed using several options:
5020 'shell' 'shellcmdflag' 'shellxquote' {expr} 'shellredir' {tmp} 'shellxquote'
5021 ({tmp} is an automatically generated file name).
5022 For Unix and OS/2 braces are put around {expr} to allow for
5023 concatenated commands.
5024
Bram Moolenaar433f7c82006-03-21 21:29:36 +00005025 The command will be executed in "cooked" mode, so that a
5026 CTRL-C will interrupt the command (on Unix at least).
5027
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005028 The resulting error code can be found in |v:shell_error|.
5029 This function will fail in |restricted-mode|.
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00005030
5031 Note that any wrong value in the options mentioned above may
5032 make the function fail. It has also been reported to fail
5033 when using a security agent application.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005034 Unlike ":!cmd" there is no automatic check for changed files.
5035 Use |:checktime| to force a check.
5036
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00005037
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00005038tabpagebuflist([{arg}]) *tabpagebuflist()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005039 The result is a |List|, where each item is the number of the
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00005040 buffer associated with each window in the current tab page.
5041 {arg} specifies the number of tab page to be used. When
5042 omitted the current tab page is used.
5043 When {arg} is invalid the number zero is returned.
5044 To get a list of all buffers in all tabs use this: >
5045 tablist = []
5046 for i in range(tabpagenr('$'))
5047 call extend(tablist, tabpagebuflist(i + 1))
5048 endfor
5049< Note that a buffer may appear in more than one window.
5050
5051
5052tabpagenr([{arg}]) *tabpagenr()*
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00005053 The result is a Number, which is the number of the current
5054 tab page. The first tab page has number 1.
5055 When the optional argument is "$", the number of the last tab
5056 page is returned (the tab page count).
5057 The number can be used with the |:tab| command.
5058
5059
Bram Moolenaarfaa959a2006-02-20 21:37:40 +00005060tabpagewinnr({tabarg}, [{arg}]) *tabpagewinnr()*
5061 Like |winnr()| but for tab page {arg}.
5062 {tabarg} specifies the number of tab page to be used.
5063 {arg} is used like with |winnr()|:
5064 - When omitted the current window number is returned. This is
5065 the window which will be used when going to this tab page.
5066 - When "$" the number of windows is returned.
5067 - When "#" the previous window nr is returned.
5068 Useful examples: >
5069 tabpagewinnr(1) " current window of tab page 1
5070 tabpagewinnr(4, '$') " number of windows in tab page 4
5071< When {tabarg} is invalid zero is returned.
5072
Bram Moolenaarfa1d1402006-03-25 21:59:56 +00005073 *tagfiles()*
5074tagfiles() Returns a |List| with the file names used to search for tags
5075 for the current buffer. This is the 'tags' option expanded.
5076
5077
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00005078taglist({expr}) *taglist()*
5079 Returns a list of tags matching the regular expression {expr}.
Bram Moolenaard8c00872005-07-22 21:52:15 +00005080 Each list item is a dictionary with at least the following
5081 entries:
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00005082 name Name of the tag.
5083 filename Name of the file where the tag is
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005084 defined. It is either relative to the
5085 current directory or a full path.
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00005086 cmd Ex command used to locate the tag in
5087 the file.
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00005088 kind Type of the tag. The value for this
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00005089 entry depends on the language specific
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005090 kind values. Only available when
5091 using a tags file generated by
5092 Exuberant ctags or hdrtag.
Bram Moolenaar280f1262006-01-30 00:14:18 +00005093 static A file specific tag. Refer to
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00005094 |static-tag| for more information.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005095 More entries may be present, depending on the content of the
5096 tags file: access, implementation, inherits and signature.
5097 Refer to the ctags documentation for information about these
5098 fields. For C code the fields "struct", "class" and "enum"
5099 may appear, they give the name of the entity the tag is
5100 contained in.
Bram Moolenaar5a8684e2005-07-30 22:43:24 +00005101
Bram Moolenaar4317d9b2005-03-18 20:25:31 +00005102 The ex-command 'cmd' can be either an ex search pattern, a
5103 line number or a line number followed by a byte number.
Bram Moolenaare2cc9702005-03-15 22:43:58 +00005104
5105 If there are no matching tags, then an empty list is returned.
5106
5107 To get an exact tag match, the anchors '^' and '$' should be
5108 used in {expr}. Refer to |tag-regexp| for more information
5109 about the tag search regular expression pattern.
5110
5111 Refer to |'tags'| for information about how the tags file is
5112 located by Vim. Refer to |tags-file-format| for the format of
5113 the tags file generated by the different ctags tools.
5114
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005115tempname() *tempname()* *temp-file-name*
5116 The result is a String, which is the name of a file that
5117 doesn't exist. It can be used for a temporary file. The name
5118 is different for at least 26 consecutive calls. Example: >
5119 :let tmpfile = tempname()
5120 :exe "redir > " . tmpfile
5121< For Unix, the file will be in a private directory (only
5122 accessible by the current user) to avoid security problems
5123 (e.g., a symlink attack or other people reading your file).
5124 When Vim exits the directory and all files in it are deleted.
5125 For MS-Windows forward slashes are used when the 'shellslash'
5126 option is set or when 'shellcmdflag' starts with '-'.
5127
5128tolower({expr}) *tolower()*
5129 The result is a copy of the String given, with all uppercase
5130 characters turned into lowercase (just like applying |gu| to
5131 the string).
5132
5133toupper({expr}) *toupper()*
5134 The result is a copy of the String given, with all lowercase
5135 characters turned into uppercase (just like applying |gU| to
5136 the string).
5137
Bram Moolenaar8299df92004-07-10 09:47:34 +00005138tr({src}, {fromstr}, {tostr}) *tr()*
5139 The result is a copy of the {src} string with all characters
5140 which appear in {fromstr} replaced by the character in that
5141 position in the {tostr} string. Thus the first character in
5142 {fromstr} is translated into the first character in {tostr}
5143 and so on. Exactly like the unix "tr" command.
5144 This code also deals with multibyte characters properly.
5145
5146 Examples: >
5147 echo tr("hello there", "ht", "HT")
5148< returns "Hello THere" >
5149 echo tr("<blob>", "<>", "{}")
5150< returns "{blob}"
5151
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00005152 *type()*
5153type({expr}) The result is a Number, depending on the type of {expr}:
Bram Moolenaar748bf032005-02-02 23:04:36 +00005154 Number: 0
5155 String: 1
5156 Funcref: 2
5157 List: 3
5158 Dictionary: 4
5159 To avoid the magic numbers it should be used this way: >
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00005160 :if type(myvar) == type(0)
5161 :if type(myvar) == type("")
5162 :if type(myvar) == type(function("tr"))
5163 :if type(myvar) == type([])
Bram Moolenaar748bf032005-02-02 23:04:36 +00005164 :if type(myvar) == type({})
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005165
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00005166values({dict}) *values()*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005167 Return a |List| with all the values of {dict}. The |List| is
5168 in arbitrary order.
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00005169
5170
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005171virtcol({expr}) *virtcol()*
5172 The result is a Number, which is the screen column of the file
5173 position given with {expr}. That is, the last screen position
5174 occupied by the character at that position, when the screen
5175 would be of unlimited width. When there is a <Tab> at the
5176 position, the returned Number will be the column at the end of
5177 the <Tab>. For example, for a <Tab> in column 1, with 'ts'
5178 set to 8, it returns 8.
Bram Moolenaar477933c2007-07-17 14:32:23 +00005179 For the byte position use |col()|.
5180 For the use of {expr} see |col()|.
5181 When 'virtualedit' is used {expr} can be [lnum, col, off], where
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00005182 "off" is the offset in screen columns from the start of the
Bram Moolenaard46bbc72007-05-12 14:38:41 +00005183 character. E.g., a position within a <Tab> or after the last
Bram Moolenaar0b238792006-03-02 22:49:12 +00005184 character.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005185 When Virtual editing is active in the current mode, a position
5186 beyond the end of the line can be returned. |'virtualedit'|
5187 The accepted positions are:
5188 . the cursor position
5189 $ the end of the cursor line (the result is the
5190 number of displayed characters in the cursor line
5191 plus one)
5192 'x position of mark x (if the mark is not set, 0 is
5193 returned)
5194 Note that only marks in the current file can be used.
5195 Examples: >
5196 virtcol(".") with text "foo^Lbar", with cursor on the "^L", returns 5
5197 virtcol("$") with text "foo^Lbar", returns 9
5198 virtcol("'t") with text " there", with 't at 'h', returns 6
5199< The first column is 1. 0 is returned for an error.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005200 A more advanced example that echoes the maximum length of
5201 all lines: >
5202 echo max(map(range(1, line('$')), "virtcol([v:val, '$'])"))
5203
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005204
5205visualmode([expr]) *visualmode()*
5206 The result is a String, which describes the last Visual mode
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00005207 used in the current buffer. Initially it returns an empty
5208 string, but once Visual mode has been used, it returns "v",
5209 "V", or "<CTRL-V>" (a single CTRL-V character) for
5210 character-wise, line-wise, or block-wise Visual mode
5211 respectively.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005212 Example: >
5213 :exe "normal " . visualmode()
5214< This enters the same Visual mode as before. It is also useful
5215 in scripts if you wish to act differently depending on the
5216 Visual mode that was used.
5217
5218 If an expression is supplied that results in a non-zero number
5219 or a non-empty string, then the Visual mode will be cleared
5220 and the old value is returned. Note that " " and "0" are also
5221 non-empty strings, thus cause the mode to be cleared.
5222
5223 *winbufnr()*
5224winbufnr({nr}) The result is a Number, which is the number of the buffer
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00005225 associated with window {nr}. When {nr} is zero, the number of
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005226 the buffer in the current window is returned. When window
5227 {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned.
5228 Example: >
5229 :echo "The file in the current window is " . bufname(winbufnr(0))
5230<
5231 *wincol()*
5232wincol() The result is a Number, which is the virtual column of the
5233 cursor in the window. This is counting screen cells from the
5234 left side of the window. The leftmost column is one.
5235
5236winheight({nr}) *winheight()*
5237 The result is a Number, which is the height of window {nr}.
5238 When {nr} is zero, the height of the current window is
5239 returned. When window {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned.
5240 An existing window always has a height of zero or more.
5241 Examples: >
5242 :echo "The current window has " . winheight(0) . " lines."
5243<
5244 *winline()*
5245winline() The result is a Number, which is the screen line of the cursor
5246 in the window. This is counting screen lines from the top of
5247 the window. The first line is one.
Bram Moolenaarbfd8fc02005-09-20 23:22:24 +00005248 If the cursor was moved the view on the file will be updated
5249 first, this may cause a scroll.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005250
5251 *winnr()*
Bram Moolenaar5eb86f92004-07-26 12:53:41 +00005252winnr([{arg}]) The result is a Number, which is the number of the current
5253 window. The top window has number 1.
5254 When the optional argument is "$", the number of the
Bram Moolenaar7e8fd632006-02-18 22:14:51 +00005255 last window is returned (the window count).
Bram Moolenaar5eb86f92004-07-26 12:53:41 +00005256 When the optional argument is "#", the number of the last
5257 accessed window is returned (where |CTRL-W_p| goes to).
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005258 If there is no previous window or it is in another tab page 0
5259 is returned.
Bram Moolenaar5eb86f92004-07-26 12:53:41 +00005260 The number can be used with |CTRL-W_w| and ":wincmd w"
5261 |:wincmd|.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005262 Also see |tabpagewinnr()|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005263
5264 *winrestcmd()*
5265winrestcmd() Returns a sequence of |:resize| commands that should restore
5266 the current window sizes. Only works properly when no windows
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00005267 are opened or closed and the current window and tab page is
5268 unchanged.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005269 Example: >
5270 :let cmd = winrestcmd()
5271 :call MessWithWindowSizes()
5272 :exe cmd
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00005273<
5274 *winrestview()*
5275winrestview({dict})
5276 Uses the |Dictionary| returned by |winsaveview()| to restore
5277 the view of the current window.
5278 If you have changed the values the result is unpredictable.
5279 If the window size changed the result won't be the same.
5280
5281 *winsaveview()*
5282winsaveview() Returns a |Dictionary| that contains information to restore
5283 the view of the current window. Use |winrestview()| to
5284 restore the view.
5285 This is useful if you have a mapping that jumps around in the
5286 buffer and you want to go back to the original view.
5287 This does not save fold information. Use the 'foldenable'
Bram Moolenaardb552d602006-03-23 22:59:57 +00005288 option to temporarily switch off folding, so that folds are
5289 not opened when moving around.
Bram Moolenaar87b5ca52006-03-04 21:55:31 +00005290 The return value includes:
5291 lnum cursor line number
5292 col cursor column
5293 coladd cursor column offset for 'virtualedit'
5294 curswant column for vertical movement
5295 topline first line in the window
5296 topfill filler lines, only in diff mode
5297 leftcol first column displayed
5298 skipcol columns skipped
5299 Note that no option values are saved.
5300
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005301
5302winwidth({nr}) *winwidth()*
5303 The result is a Number, which is the width of window {nr}.
5304 When {nr} is zero, the width of the current window is
5305 returned. When window {nr} doesn't exist, -1 is returned.
5306 An existing window always has a width of zero or more.
5307 Examples: >
5308 :echo "The current window has " . winwidth(0) . " columns."
5309 :if winwidth(0) <= 50
5310 : exe "normal 50\<C-W>|"
5311 :endif
5312<
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00005313 *writefile()*
5314writefile({list}, {fname} [, {binary}])
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005315 Write |List| {list} to file {fname}. Each list item is
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00005316 separated with a NL. Each list item must be a String or
5317 Number.
5318 When {binary} is equal to "b" binary mode is used: There will
5319 not be a NL after the last list item. An empty item at the
5320 end does cause the last line in the file to end in a NL.
5321 All NL characters are replaced with a NUL character.
5322 Inserting CR characters needs to be done before passing {list}
5323 to writefile().
5324 An existing file is overwritten, if possible.
5325 When the write fails -1 is returned, otherwise 0. There is an
5326 error message if the file can't be created or when writing
5327 fails.
5328 Also see |readfile()|.
5329 To copy a file byte for byte: >
5330 :let fl = readfile("foo", "b")
5331 :call writefile(fl, "foocopy", "b")
5332<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005333
5334 *feature-list*
5335There are three types of features:
53361. Features that are only supported when they have been enabled when Vim
5337 was compiled |+feature-list|. Example: >
5338 :if has("cindent")
53392. Features that are only supported when certain conditions have been met.
5340 Example: >
5341 :if has("gui_running")
5342< *has-patch*
53433. Included patches. First check |v:version| for the version of Vim.
5344 Then the "patch123" feature means that patch 123 has been included for
5345 this version. Example (checking version 6.2.148 or later): >
5346 :if v:version > 602 || v:version == 602 && has("patch148")
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005347< Note that it's possible for patch 147 to be omitted even though 148 is
5348 included.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005349
5350all_builtin_terms Compiled with all builtin terminals enabled.
5351amiga Amiga version of Vim.
5352arabic Compiled with Arabic support |Arabic|.
5353arp Compiled with ARP support (Amiga).
Bram Moolenaara9b1e742005-12-19 22:14:58 +00005354autocmd Compiled with autocommand support. |autocommand|
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005355balloon_eval Compiled with |balloon-eval| support.
Bram Moolenaar45360022005-07-21 21:08:21 +00005356balloon_multiline GUI supports multiline balloons.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005357beos BeOS version of Vim.
5358browse Compiled with |:browse| support, and browse() will
5359 work.
5360builtin_terms Compiled with some builtin terminals.
5361byte_offset Compiled with support for 'o' in 'statusline'
5362cindent Compiled with 'cindent' support.
5363clientserver Compiled with remote invocation support |clientserver|.
5364clipboard Compiled with 'clipboard' support.
5365cmdline_compl Compiled with |cmdline-completion| support.
5366cmdline_hist Compiled with |cmdline-history| support.
5367cmdline_info Compiled with 'showcmd' and 'ruler' support.
5368comments Compiled with |'comments'| support.
5369cryptv Compiled with encryption support |encryption|.
5370cscope Compiled with |cscope| support.
5371compatible Compiled to be very Vi compatible.
5372debug Compiled with "DEBUG" defined.
5373dialog_con Compiled with console dialog support.
5374dialog_gui Compiled with GUI dialog support.
5375diff Compiled with |vimdiff| and 'diff' support.
5376digraphs Compiled with support for digraphs.
5377dnd Compiled with support for the "~ register |quote_~|.
5378dos32 32 bits DOS (DJGPP) version of Vim.
5379dos16 16 bits DOS version of Vim.
5380ebcdic Compiled on a machine with ebcdic character set.
5381emacs_tags Compiled with support for Emacs tags.
5382eval Compiled with expression evaluation support. Always
5383 true, of course!
5384ex_extra Compiled with extra Ex commands |+ex_extra|.
5385extra_search Compiled with support for |'incsearch'| and
5386 |'hlsearch'|
5387farsi Compiled with Farsi support |farsi|.
5388file_in_path Compiled with support for |gf| and |<cfile>|
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005389filterpipe When 'shelltemp' is off pipes are used for shell
5390 read/write/filter commands
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005391find_in_path Compiled with support for include file searches
5392 |+find_in_path|.
5393fname_case Case in file names matters (for Amiga, MS-DOS, and
5394 Windows this is not present).
5395folding Compiled with |folding| support.
5396footer Compiled with GUI footer support. |gui-footer|
5397fork Compiled to use fork()/exec() instead of system().
5398gettext Compiled with message translation |multi-lang|
5399gui Compiled with GUI enabled.
5400gui_athena Compiled with Athena GUI.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005401gui_gtk Compiled with GTK+ GUI (any version).
5402gui_gtk2 Compiled with GTK+ 2 GUI (gui_gtk is also defined).
5403gui_mac Compiled with Macintosh GUI.
5404gui_motif Compiled with Motif GUI.
5405gui_photon Compiled with Photon GUI.
5406gui_win32 Compiled with MS Windows Win32 GUI.
5407gui_win32s idem, and Win32s system being used (Windows 3.1)
5408gui_running Vim is running in the GUI, or it will start soon.
5409hangul_input Compiled with Hangul input support. |hangul|
5410iconv Can use iconv() for conversion.
5411insert_expand Compiled with support for CTRL-X expansion commands in
5412 Insert mode.
5413jumplist Compiled with |jumplist| support.
5414keymap Compiled with 'keymap' support.
5415langmap Compiled with 'langmap' support.
5416libcall Compiled with |libcall()| support.
5417linebreak Compiled with 'linebreak', 'breakat' and 'showbreak'
5418 support.
5419lispindent Compiled with support for lisp indenting.
5420listcmds Compiled with commands for the buffer list |:files|
5421 and the argument list |arglist|.
5422localmap Compiled with local mappings and abbr. |:map-local|
5423mac Macintosh version of Vim.
5424macunix Macintosh version of Vim, using Unix files (OS-X).
5425menu Compiled with support for |:menu|.
5426mksession Compiled with support for |:mksession|.
5427modify_fname Compiled with file name modifiers. |filename-modifiers|
5428mouse Compiled with support mouse.
5429mouseshape Compiled with support for 'mouseshape'.
5430mouse_dec Compiled with support for Dec terminal mouse.
5431mouse_gpm Compiled with support for gpm (Linux console mouse)
5432mouse_netterm Compiled with support for netterm mouse.
5433mouse_pterm Compiled with support for qnx pterm mouse.
5434mouse_xterm Compiled with support for xterm mouse.
5435multi_byte Compiled with support for editing Korean et al.
5436multi_byte_ime Compiled with support for IME input method.
5437multi_lang Compiled with support for multiple languages.
Bram Moolenaar325b7a22004-07-05 15:58:32 +00005438mzscheme Compiled with MzScheme interface |mzscheme|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005439netbeans_intg Compiled with support for |netbeans|.
Bram Moolenaar009b2592004-10-24 19:18:58 +00005440netbeans_enabled Compiled with support for |netbeans| and it's used.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005441ole Compiled with OLE automation support for Win32.
5442os2 OS/2 version of Vim.
5443osfiletype Compiled with support for osfiletypes |+osfiletype|
5444path_extra Compiled with up/downwards search in 'path' and 'tags'
5445perl Compiled with Perl interface.
5446postscript Compiled with PostScript file printing.
5447printer Compiled with |:hardcopy| support.
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00005448profile Compiled with |:profile| support.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005449python Compiled with Python interface.
5450qnx QNX version of Vim.
5451quickfix Compiled with |quickfix| support.
Bram Moolenaard68071d2006-05-02 22:08:30 +00005452reltime Compiled with |reltime()| support.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005453rightleft Compiled with 'rightleft' support.
5454ruby Compiled with Ruby interface |ruby|.
5455scrollbind Compiled with 'scrollbind' support.
5456showcmd Compiled with 'showcmd' support.
5457signs Compiled with |:sign| support.
5458smartindent Compiled with 'smartindent' support.
Bram Moolenaar69a7cb42004-06-20 12:51:53 +00005459sniff Compiled with SNiFF interface support.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005460statusline Compiled with support for 'statusline', 'rulerformat'
5461 and special formats of 'titlestring' and 'iconstring'.
5462sun_workshop Compiled with support for Sun |workshop|.
Bram Moolenaar82cf9b62005-06-07 21:09:25 +00005463spell Compiled with spell checking support |spell|.
5464syntax Compiled with syntax highlighting support |syntax|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005465syntax_items There are active syntax highlighting items for the
5466 current buffer.
5467system Compiled to use system() instead of fork()/exec().
5468tag_binary Compiled with binary searching in tags files
5469 |tag-binary-search|.
5470tag_old_static Compiled with support for old static tags
5471 |tag-old-static|.
5472tag_any_white Compiled with support for any white characters in tags
5473 files |tag-any-white|.
5474tcl Compiled with Tcl interface.
5475terminfo Compiled with terminfo instead of termcap.
5476termresponse Compiled with support for |t_RV| and |v:termresponse|.
5477textobjects Compiled with support for |text-objects|.
5478tgetent Compiled with tgetent support, able to use a termcap
5479 or terminfo file.
5480title Compiled with window title support |'title'|.
5481toolbar Compiled with support for |gui-toolbar|.
5482unix Unix version of Vim.
5483user_commands User-defined commands.
5484viminfo Compiled with viminfo support.
5485vim_starting True while initial source'ing takes place.
5486vertsplit Compiled with vertically split windows |:vsplit|.
5487virtualedit Compiled with 'virtualedit' option.
5488visual Compiled with Visual mode.
5489visualextra Compiled with extra Visual mode commands.
5490 |blockwise-operators|.
5491vms VMS version of Vim.
5492vreplace Compiled with |gR| and |gr| commands.
5493wildignore Compiled with 'wildignore' option.
5494wildmenu Compiled with 'wildmenu' option.
5495windows Compiled with support for more than one window.
5496winaltkeys Compiled with 'winaltkeys' option.
5497win16 Win16 version of Vim (MS-Windows 3.1).
5498win32 Win32 version of Vim (MS-Windows 95/98/ME/NT/2000/XP).
5499win64 Win64 version of Vim (MS-Windows 64 bit).
5500win32unix Win32 version of Vim, using Unix files (Cygwin)
5501win95 Win32 version for MS-Windows 95/98/ME.
5502writebackup Compiled with 'writebackup' default on.
5503xfontset Compiled with X fontset support |xfontset|.
5504xim Compiled with X input method support |xim|.
5505xsmp Compiled with X session management support.
5506xsmp_interact Compiled with interactive X session management support.
5507xterm_clipboard Compiled with support for xterm clipboard.
5508xterm_save Compiled with support for saving and restoring the
5509 xterm screen.
5510x11 Compiled with X11 support.
5511
5512 *string-match*
5513Matching a pattern in a String
5514
5515A regexp pattern as explained at |pattern| is normally used to find a match in
5516the buffer lines. When a pattern is used to find a match in a String, almost
5517everything works in the same way. The difference is that a String is handled
5518like it is one line. When it contains a "\n" character, this is not seen as a
5519line break for the pattern. It can be matched with a "\n" in the pattern, or
5520with ".". Example: >
5521 :let a = "aaaa\nxxxx"
5522 :echo matchstr(a, "..\n..")
5523 aa
5524 xx
5525 :echo matchstr(a, "a.x")
5526 a
5527 x
5528
5529Don't forget that "^" will only match at the first character of the String and
5530"$" at the last character of the string. They don't match after or before a
5531"\n".
5532
5533==============================================================================
55345. Defining functions *user-functions*
5535
5536New functions can be defined. These can be called just like builtin
5537functions. The function executes a sequence of Ex commands. Normal mode
5538commands can be executed with the |:normal| command.
5539
5540The function name must start with an uppercase letter, to avoid confusion with
5541builtin functions. To prevent from using the same name in different scripts
5542avoid obvious, short names. A good habit is to start the function name with
5543the name of the script, e.g., "HTMLcolor()".
5544
Bram Moolenaar92d640f2005-09-05 22:11:52 +00005545It's also possible to use curly braces, see |curly-braces-names|. And the
5546|autoload| facility is useful to define a function only when it's called.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005547
5548 *local-function*
5549A function local to a script must start with "s:". A local script function
5550can only be called from within the script and from functions, user commands
5551and autocommands defined in the script. It is also possible to call the
5552function from a mappings defined in the script, but then |<SID>| must be used
5553instead of "s:" when the mapping is expanded outside of the script.
5554
5555 *:fu* *:function* *E128* *E129* *E123*
5556:fu[nction] List all functions and their arguments.
5557
5558:fu[nction] {name} List function {name}.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005559 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a
5560 |Funcref|: >
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005561 :function dict.init
Bram Moolenaar92d640f2005-09-05 22:11:52 +00005562
5563:fu[nction] /{pattern} List functions with a name matching {pattern}.
5564 Example that lists all functions ending with "File": >
5565 :function /File$
Bram Moolenaar5b8d8fd2005-08-16 23:01:50 +00005566<
5567 *:function-verbose*
5568When 'verbose' is non-zero, listing a function will also display where it was
5569last defined. Example: >
5570
5571 :verbose function SetFileTypeSH
5572 function SetFileTypeSH(name)
5573 Last set from /usr/share/vim/vim-7.0/filetype.vim
5574<
Bram Moolenaar8aff23a2005-08-19 20:40:30 +00005575See |:verbose-cmd| for more information.
Bram Moolenaar5b8d8fd2005-08-16 23:01:50 +00005576
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00005577 *E124* *E125*
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00005578:fu[nction][!] {name}([arguments]) [range] [abort] [dict]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005579 Define a new function by the name {name}. The name
5580 must be made of alphanumeric characters and '_', and
5581 must start with a capital or "s:" (see above).
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005582
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005583 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a
5584 |Funcref|: >
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005585 :function dict.init(arg)
5586< "dict" must be an existing dictionary. The entry
5587 "init" is added if it didn't exist yet. Otherwise [!]
5588 is required to overwrite an existing function. The
5589 result is a |Funcref| to a numbered function. The
5590 function can only be used with a |Funcref| and will be
5591 deleted if there are no more references to it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005592 *E127* *E122*
5593 When a function by this name already exists and [!] is
5594 not used an error message is given. When [!] is used,
5595 an existing function is silently replaced. Unless it
5596 is currently being executed, that is an error.
Bram Moolenaar8f999f12005-01-25 22:12:55 +00005597
5598 For the {arguments} see |function-argument|.
5599
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005600 *a:firstline* *a:lastline*
5601 When the [range] argument is added, the function is
5602 expected to take care of a range itself. The range is
5603 passed as "a:firstline" and "a:lastline". If [range]
5604 is excluded, ":{range}call" will call the function for
5605 each line in the range, with the cursor on the start
5606 of each line. See |function-range-example|.
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005607
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005608 When the [abort] argument is added, the function will
5609 abort as soon as an error is detected.
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005610
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00005611 When the [dict] argument is added, the function must
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005612 be invoked through an entry in a |Dictionary|. The
Bram Moolenaar2fda12f2005-01-15 22:14:15 +00005613 local variable "self" will then be set to the
5614 dictionary. See |Dictionary-function|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005615
Bram Moolenaar98692072006-02-04 00:57:42 +00005616 The last used search pattern and the redo command "."
5617 will not be changed by the function.
5618
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005619 *:endf* *:endfunction* *E126* *E193*
5620:endf[unction] The end of a function definition. Must be on a line
5621 by its own, without other commands.
5622
5623 *:delf* *:delfunction* *E130* *E131*
5624:delf[unction] {name} Delete function {name}.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005625 {name} can also be a |Dictionary| entry that is a
5626 |Funcref|: >
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005627 :delfunc dict.init
5628< This will remove the "init" entry from "dict". The
5629 function is deleted if there are no more references to
5630 it.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005631 *:retu* *:return* *E133*
5632:retu[rn] [expr] Return from a function. When "[expr]" is given, it is
5633 evaluated and returned as the result of the function.
5634 If "[expr]" is not given, the number 0 is returned.
5635 When a function ends without an explicit ":return",
5636 the number 0 is returned.
5637 Note that there is no check for unreachable lines,
5638 thus there is no warning if commands follow ":return".
5639
5640 If the ":return" is used after a |:try| but before the
5641 matching |:finally| (if present), the commands
5642 following the ":finally" up to the matching |:endtry|
5643 are executed first. This process applies to all
5644 nested ":try"s inside the function. The function
5645 returns at the outermost ":endtry".
5646
Bram Moolenaar8f999f12005-01-25 22:12:55 +00005647 *function-argument* *a:var*
5648An argument can be defined by giving its name. In the function this can then
5649be used as "a:name" ("a:" for argument).
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005650 *a:0* *a:1* *a:000* *E740* *...*
Bram Moolenaar8f999f12005-01-25 22:12:55 +00005651Up to 20 arguments can be given, separated by commas. After the named
5652arguments an argument "..." can be specified, which means that more arguments
5653may optionally be following. In the function the extra arguments can be used
5654as "a:1", "a:2", etc. "a:0" is set to the number of extra arguments (which
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005655can be 0). "a:000" is set to a |List| that contains these arguments. Note
5656that "a:1" is the same as "a:000[0]".
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00005657 *E742*
5658The a: scope and the variables in it cannot be changed, they are fixed.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005659However, if a |List| or |Dictionary| is used, you can changes their contents.
5660Thus you can pass a |List| to a function and have the function add an item to
5661it. If you want to make sure the function cannot change a |List| or
5662|Dictionary| use |:lockvar|.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005663
Bram Moolenaar8f999f12005-01-25 22:12:55 +00005664When not using "...", the number of arguments in a function call must be equal
5665to the number of named arguments. When using "...", the number of arguments
5666may be larger.
5667
5668It is also possible to define a function without any arguments. You must
5669still supply the () then. The body of the function follows in the next lines,
5670until the matching |:endfunction|. It is allowed to define another function
5671inside a function body.
5672
5673 *local-variables*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005674Inside a function variables can be used. These are local variables, which
5675will disappear when the function returns. Global variables need to be
5676accessed with "g:".
5677
5678Example: >
5679 :function Table(title, ...)
5680 : echohl Title
5681 : echo a:title
5682 : echohl None
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00005683 : echo a:0 . " items:"
5684 : for s in a:000
5685 : echon ' ' . s
5686 : endfor
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005687 :endfunction
5688
5689This function can then be called with: >
Bram Moolenaar677ee682005-01-27 14:41:15 +00005690 call Table("Table", "line1", "line2")
5691 call Table("Empty Table")
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005692
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005693To return more than one value, return a |List|: >
5694 :function Compute(n1, n2)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005695 : if a:n2 == 0
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005696 : return ["fail", 0]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005697 : endif
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005698 : return ["ok", a:n1 / a:n2]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005699 :endfunction
5700
5701This function can then be called with: >
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005702 :let [success, div] = Compute(102, 6)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005703 :if success == "ok"
5704 : echo div
5705 :endif
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005706<
Bram Moolenaar39f05632006-03-19 22:15:26 +00005707 *:cal* *:call* *E107* *E117*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005708:[range]cal[l] {name}([arguments])
5709 Call a function. The name of the function and its arguments
5710 are as specified with |:function|. Up to 20 arguments can be
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005711 used. The returned value is discarded.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005712 Without a range and for functions that accept a range, the
5713 function is called once. When a range is given the cursor is
5714 positioned at the start of the first line before executing the
5715 function.
5716 When a range is given and the function doesn't handle it
5717 itself, the function is executed for each line in the range,
5718 with the cursor in the first column of that line. The cursor
5719 is left at the last line (possibly moved by the last function
5720 call). The arguments are re-evaluated for each line. Thus
5721 this works:
5722 *function-range-example* >
5723 :function Mynumber(arg)
5724 : echo line(".") . " " . a:arg
5725 :endfunction
5726 :1,5call Mynumber(getline("."))
5727<
5728 The "a:firstline" and "a:lastline" are defined anyway, they
5729 can be used to do something different at the start or end of
5730 the range.
5731
5732 Example of a function that handles the range itself: >
5733
5734 :function Cont() range
5735 : execute (a:firstline + 1) . "," . a:lastline . 's/^/\t\\ '
5736 :endfunction
5737 :4,8call Cont()
5738<
5739 This function inserts the continuation character "\" in front
5740 of all the lines in the range, except the first one.
5741
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005742 When the function returns a composite value it can be further
5743 dereferenced, but the range will not be used then. Example: >
5744 :4,8call GetDict().method()
5745< Here GetDict() gets the range but method() does not.
5746
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005747 *E132*
5748The recursiveness of user functions is restricted with the |'maxfuncdepth'|
5749option.
5750
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005751
5752AUTOMATICALLY LOADING FUNCTIONS ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005753 *autoload-functions*
5754When using many or large functions, it's possible to automatically define them
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005755only when they are used. There are two methods: with an autocommand and with
5756the "autoload" directory in 'runtimepath'.
5757
5758
5759Using an autocommand ~
5760
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00005761This is introduced in the user manual, section |41.14|.
5762
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005763The autocommand is useful if you have a plugin that is a long Vim script file.
5764You can define the autocommand and quickly quit the script with |:finish|.
5765That makes Vim startup faster. The autocommand should then load the same file
5766again, setting a variable to skip the |:finish| command.
5767
5768Use the FuncUndefined autocommand event with a pattern that matches the
5769function(s) to be defined. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005770
5771 :au FuncUndefined BufNet* source ~/vim/bufnetfuncs.vim
5772
5773The file "~/vim/bufnetfuncs.vim" should then define functions that start with
5774"BufNet". Also see |FuncUndefined|.
5775
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005776
5777Using an autoload script ~
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005778 *autoload* *E746*
Bram Moolenaar05159a02005-02-26 23:04:13 +00005779This is introduced in the user manual, section |41.15|.
5780
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005781Using a script in the "autoload" directory is simpler, but requires using
5782exactly the right file name. A function that can be autoloaded has a name
5783like this: >
5784
Bram Moolenaara7fc0102005-05-18 22:17:12 +00005785 :call filename#funcname()
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005786
5787When such a function is called, and it is not defined yet, Vim will search the
5788"autoload" directories in 'runtimepath' for a script file called
5789"filename.vim". For example "~/.vim/autoload/filename.vim". That file should
5790then define the function like this: >
5791
Bram Moolenaara7fc0102005-05-18 22:17:12 +00005792 function filename#funcname()
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005793 echo "Done!"
5794 endfunction
5795
Bram Moolenaar60a795a2005-09-16 21:55:43 +00005796The file name and the name used before the # in the function must match
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005797exactly, and the defined function must have the name exactly as it will be
5798called.
5799
Bram Moolenaara7fc0102005-05-18 22:17:12 +00005800It is possible to use subdirectories. Every # in the function name works like
5801a path separator. Thus when calling a function: >
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005802
Bram Moolenaara7fc0102005-05-18 22:17:12 +00005803 :call foo#bar#func()
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005804
5805Vim will look for the file "autoload/foo/bar.vim" in 'runtimepath'.
5806
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005807This also works when reading a variable that has not been set yet: >
5808
Bram Moolenaara7fc0102005-05-18 22:17:12 +00005809 :let l = foo#bar#lvar
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005810
Bram Moolenaara5792f52005-11-23 21:25:05 +00005811However, when the autoload script was already loaded it won't be loaded again
5812for an unknown variable.
5813
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005814When assigning a value to such a variable nothing special happens. This can
5815be used to pass settings to the autoload script before it's loaded: >
5816
Bram Moolenaara7fc0102005-05-18 22:17:12 +00005817 :let foo#bar#toggle = 1
5818 :call foo#bar#func()
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005819
Bram Moolenaar4399ef42005-02-12 14:29:27 +00005820Note that when you make a mistake and call a function that is supposed to be
5821defined in an autoload script, but the script doesn't actually define the
5822function, the script will be sourced every time you try to call the function.
Bram Moolenaar26a60b42005-02-22 08:49:11 +00005823And you will get an error message every time.
5824
5825Also note that if you have two script files, and one calls a function in the
5826other and vise versa, before the used function is defined, it won't work.
5827Avoid using the autoload functionality at the toplevel.
Bram Moolenaar7c626922005-02-07 22:01:03 +00005828
Bram Moolenaar433f7c82006-03-21 21:29:36 +00005829Hint: If you distribute a bunch of scripts you can pack them together with the
5830|vimball| utility. Also read the user manual |distribute-script|.
5831
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005832==============================================================================
58336. Curly braces names *curly-braces-names*
5834
5835Wherever you can use a variable, you can use a "curly braces name" variable.
5836This is a regular variable name with one or more expressions wrapped in braces
5837{} like this: >
5838 my_{adjective}_variable
5839
5840When Vim encounters this, it evaluates the expression inside the braces, puts
5841that in place of the expression, and re-interprets the whole as a variable
5842name. So in the above example, if the variable "adjective" was set to
5843"noisy", then the reference would be to "my_noisy_variable", whereas if
5844"adjective" was set to "quiet", then it would be to "my_quiet_variable".
5845
5846One application for this is to create a set of variables governed by an option
5847value. For example, the statement >
5848 echo my_{&background}_message
5849
5850would output the contents of "my_dark_message" or "my_light_message" depending
5851on the current value of 'background'.
5852
5853You can use multiple brace pairs: >
5854 echo my_{adverb}_{adjective}_message
5855..or even nest them: >
5856 echo my_{ad{end_of_word}}_message
5857where "end_of_word" is either "verb" or "jective".
5858
5859However, the expression inside the braces must evaluate to a valid single
Bram Moolenaar402d2fe2005-04-15 21:00:38 +00005860variable name, e.g. this is invalid: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005861 :let foo='a + b'
5862 :echo c{foo}d
5863.. since the result of expansion is "ca + bd", which is not a variable name.
5864
5865 *curly-braces-function-names*
5866You can call and define functions by an evaluated name in a similar way.
5867Example: >
5868 :let func_end='whizz'
5869 :call my_func_{func_end}(parameter)
5870
5871This would call the function "my_func_whizz(parameter)".
5872
5873==============================================================================
58747. Commands *expression-commands*
5875
5876:let {var-name} = {expr1} *:let* *E18*
5877 Set internal variable {var-name} to the result of the
5878 expression {expr1}. The variable will get the type
5879 from the {expr}. If {var-name} didn't exist yet, it
5880 is created.
5881
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +00005882:let {var-name}[{idx}] = {expr1} *E689*
5883 Set a list item to the result of the expression
5884 {expr1}. {var-name} must refer to a list and {idx}
5885 must be a valid index in that list. For nested list
5886 the index can be repeated.
5887 This cannot be used to add an item to a list.
5888
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005889 *E711* *E719*
5890:let {var-name}[{idx1}:{idx2}] = {expr1} *E708* *E709* *E710*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005891 Set a sequence of items in a |List| to the result of
5892 the expression {expr1}, which must be a list with the
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00005893 correct number of items.
5894 {idx1} can be omitted, zero is used instead.
5895 {idx2} can be omitted, meaning the end of the list.
5896 When the selected range of items is partly past the
5897 end of the list, items will be added.
5898
Bram Moolenaar748bf032005-02-02 23:04:36 +00005899 *:let+=* *:let-=* *:let.=* *E734*
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005900:let {var} += {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} + {expr1}".
5901:let {var} -= {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} - {expr1}".
5902:let {var} .= {expr1} Like ":let {var} = {var} . {expr1}".
5903 These fail if {var} was not set yet and when the type
5904 of {var} and {expr1} don't fit the operator.
5905
5906
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005907:let ${env-name} = {expr1} *:let-environment* *:let-$*
5908 Set environment variable {env-name} to the result of
5909 the expression {expr1}. The type is always String.
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005910:let ${env-name} .= {expr1}
5911 Append {expr1} to the environment variable {env-name}.
5912 If the environment variable didn't exist yet this
5913 works like "=".
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005914
5915:let @{reg-name} = {expr1} *:let-register* *:let-@*
5916 Write the result of the expression {expr1} in register
5917 {reg-name}. {reg-name} must be a single letter, and
5918 must be the name of a writable register (see
5919 |registers|). "@@" can be used for the unnamed
5920 register, "@/" for the search pattern.
5921 If the result of {expr1} ends in a <CR> or <NL>, the
5922 register will be linewise, otherwise it will be set to
5923 characterwise.
5924 This can be used to clear the last search pattern: >
5925 :let @/ = ""
5926< This is different from searching for an empty string,
5927 that would match everywhere.
5928
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005929:let @{reg-name} .= {expr1}
5930 Append {expr1} to register {reg-name}. If the
5931 register was empty it's like setting it to {expr1}.
5932
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00005933:let &{option-name} = {expr1} *:let-option* *:let-&*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005934 Set option {option-name} to the result of the
Bram Moolenaarfca34d62005-01-04 21:38:36 +00005935 expression {expr1}. A String or Number value is
5936 always converted to the type of the option.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005937 For an option local to a window or buffer the effect
5938 is just like using the |:set| command: both the local
Bram Moolenaara5fac542005-10-12 20:58:49 +00005939 value and the global value are changed.
Bram Moolenaarfca34d62005-01-04 21:38:36 +00005940 Example: >
5941 :let &path = &path . ',/usr/local/include'
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005942
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005943:let &{option-name} .= {expr1}
5944 For a string option: Append {expr1} to the value.
5945 Does not insert a comma like |:set+=|.
5946
5947:let &{option-name} += {expr1}
5948:let &{option-name} -= {expr1}
5949 For a number or boolean option: Add or subtract
5950 {expr1}.
5951
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005952:let &l:{option-name} = {expr1}
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005953:let &l:{option-name} .= {expr1}
5954:let &l:{option-name} += {expr1}
5955:let &l:{option-name} -= {expr1}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005956 Like above, but only set the local value of an option
5957 (if there is one). Works like |:setlocal|.
5958
5959:let &g:{option-name} = {expr1}
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005960:let &g:{option-name} .= {expr1}
5961:let &g:{option-name} += {expr1}
5962:let &g:{option-name} -= {expr1}
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00005963 Like above, but only set the global value of an option
5964 (if there is one). Works like |:setglobal|.
5965
Bram Moolenaar13065c42005-01-08 16:08:21 +00005966:let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] = {expr1} *:let-unpack* *E687* *E688*
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005967 {expr1} must evaluate to a |List|. The first item in
Bram Moolenaarfca34d62005-01-04 21:38:36 +00005968 the list is assigned to {name1}, the second item to
5969 {name2}, etc.
5970 The number of names must match the number of items in
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005971 the |List|.
Bram Moolenaarfca34d62005-01-04 21:38:36 +00005972 Each name can be one of the items of the ":let"
5973 command as mentioned above.
5974 Example: >
5975 :let [s, item] = GetItem(s)
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005976< Detail: {expr1} is evaluated first, then the
5977 assignments are done in sequence. This matters if
5978 {name2} depends on {name1}. Example: >
5979 :let x = [0, 1]
5980 :let i = 0
5981 :let [i, x[i]] = [1, 2]
5982 :echo x
5983< The result is [0, 2].
5984
5985:let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] .= {expr1}
5986:let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] += {expr1}
5987:let [{name1}, {name2}, ...] -= {expr1}
5988 Like above, but append/add/subtract the value for each
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005989 |List| item.
Bram Moolenaarfca34d62005-01-04 21:38:36 +00005990
5991:let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] = {expr1}
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00005992 Like |:let-unpack| above, but the |List| may have more
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005993 items than there are names. A list of the remaining
5994 items is assigned to {lastname}. If there are no
5995 remaining items {lastname} is set to an empty list.
Bram Moolenaarfca34d62005-01-04 21:38:36 +00005996 Example: >
5997 :let [a, b; rest] = ["aval", "bval", 3, 4]
5998<
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00005999:let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] .= {expr1}
6000:let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] += {expr1}
6001:let [{name}, ..., ; {lastname}] -= {expr1}
6002 Like above, but append/add/subtract the value for each
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00006003 |List| item.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006004 *E106*
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00006005:let {var-name} .. List the value of variable {var-name}. Multiple
Bram Moolenaardcaf10e2005-01-21 11:55:25 +00006006 variable names may be given. Special names recognized
6007 here: *E738*
Bram Moolenaarca003e12006-03-17 23:19:38 +00006008 g: global variables
6009 b: local buffer variables
6010 w: local window variables
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00006011 t: local tab page variables
Bram Moolenaarca003e12006-03-17 23:19:38 +00006012 s: script-local variables
6013 l: local function variables
Bram Moolenaardcaf10e2005-01-21 11:55:25 +00006014 v: Vim variables.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006015
Bram Moolenaard7ee7ce2005-01-03 21:02:03 +00006016:let List the values of all variables. The type of the
6017 variable is indicated before the value:
6018 <nothing> String
6019 # Number
Bram Moolenaarc9b4b052006-04-30 18:54:39 +00006020 * Funcref
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006021
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00006022
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00006023:unl[et][!] {name} ... *:unlet* *:unl* *E108* *E795*
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00006024 Remove the internal variable {name}. Several variable
6025 names can be given, they are all removed. The name
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00006026 may also be a |List| or |Dictionary| item.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006027 With [!] no error message is given for non-existing
6028 variables.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00006029 One or more items from a |List| can be removed: >
Bram Moolenaar9cd15162005-01-16 22:02:49 +00006030 :unlet list[3] " remove fourth item
6031 :unlet list[3:] " remove fourth item to last
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00006032< One item from a |Dictionary| can be removed at a time: >
Bram Moolenaar9cd15162005-01-16 22:02:49 +00006033 :unlet dict['two']
6034 :unlet dict.two
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006035
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00006036:lockv[ar][!] [depth] {name} ... *:lockvar* *:lockv*
6037 Lock the internal variable {name}. Locking means that
6038 it can no longer be changed (until it is unlocked).
6039 A locked variable can be deleted: >
6040 :lockvar v
6041 :let v = 'asdf' " fails!
6042 :unlet v
6043< *E741*
6044 If you try to change a locked variable you get an
6045 error message: "E741: Value of {name} is locked"
6046
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00006047 [depth] is relevant when locking a |List| or
6048 |Dictionary|. It specifies how deep the locking goes:
6049 1 Lock the |List| or |Dictionary| itself,
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00006050 cannot add or remove items, but can
6051 still change their values.
6052 2 Also lock the values, cannot change
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00006053 the items. If an item is a |List| or
6054 |Dictionary|, cannot add or remove
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00006055 items, but can still change the
6056 values.
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00006057 3 Like 2 but for the |List| /
6058 |Dictionary| in the |List| /
6059 |Dictionary|, one level deeper.
6060 The default [depth] is 2, thus when {name} is a |List|
6061 or |Dictionary| the values cannot be changed.
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00006062 *E743*
6063 For unlimited depth use [!] and omit [depth].
6064 However, there is a maximum depth of 100 to catch
6065 loops.
6066
Bram Moolenaar32466aa2006-02-24 23:53:04 +00006067 Note that when two variables refer to the same |List|
6068 and you lock one of them, the |List| will also be
Bram Moolenaar910f66f2006-04-05 20:41:53 +00006069 locked when used through the other variable.
6070 Example: >
Bram Moolenaar2ce06f62005-01-31 19:19:04 +00006071 :let l = [0, 1, 2, 3]
6072 :let cl = l
6073 :lockvar l
6074 :let cl[1] = 99 " won't work!
6075< You may want to make a copy of a list to avoid this.
6076 See |deepcopy()|.
6077
6078
6079:unlo[ckvar][!] [depth] {name} ... *:unlockvar* *:unlo*
6080 Unlock the internal variable {name}. Does the
6081 opposite of |:lockvar|.
6082
6083
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006084:if {expr1} *:if* *:endif* *:en* *E171* *E579* *E580*
6085:en[dif] Execute the commands until the next matching ":else"
6086 or ":endif" if {expr1} evaluates to non-zero.
6087
6088 From Vim version 4.5 until 5.0, every Ex command in
6089 between the ":if" and ":endif" is ignored. These two
6090 commands were just to allow for future expansions in a
6091 backwards compatible way. Nesting was allowed. Note
6092 that any ":else" or ":elseif" was ignored, the "else"
6093 part was not executed either.
6094
6095 You can use this to remain compatible with older
6096 versions: >
6097 :if version >= 500
6098 : version-5-specific-commands
6099 :endif
6100< The commands still need to be parsed to find the
6101 "endif". Sometimes an older Vim has a problem with a
6102 new command. For example, ":silent" is recognized as
6103 a ":substitute" command. In that case ":execute" can
6104 avoid problems: >
6105 :if version >= 600
6106 : execute "silent 1,$delete"
6107 :endif
6108<
6109 NOTE: The ":append" and ":insert" commands don't work
6110 properly in between ":if" and ":endif".
6111
6112 *:else* *:el* *E581* *E583*
6113:el[se] Execute the commands until the next matching ":else"
6114 or ":endif" if they previously were not being
6115 executed.
6116
6117 *:elseif* *:elsei* *E582* *E584*
6118:elsei[f] {expr1} Short for ":else" ":if", with the addition that there
6119 is no extra ":endif".
6120
6121:wh[ile] {expr1} *:while* *:endwhile* *:wh* *:endw*
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00006122 *E170* *E585* *E588* *E733*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006123:endw[hile] Repeat the commands between ":while" and ":endwhile",
6124 as long as {expr1} evaluates to non-zero.
6125 When an error is detected from a command inside the
6126 loop, execution continues after the "endwhile".
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006127 Example: >
6128 :let lnum = 1
6129 :while lnum <= line("$")
6130 :call FixLine(lnum)
6131 :let lnum = lnum + 1
6132 :endwhile
6133<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006134 NOTE: The ":append" and ":insert" commands don't work
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00006135 properly inside a ":while" and ":for" loop.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006136
Bram Moolenaar3a3a7232005-01-17 22:16:15 +00006137:for {var} in {list} *:for* *E690* *E732*
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006138:endfo[r] *:endfo* *:endfor*
6139 Repeat the commands between ":for" and ":endfor" for
Bram Moolenaar3a7c85b2005-02-05 21:39:53 +00006140 each item in {list}. Variable {var} is set to the
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00006141 value of each item.
6142 When an error is detected for a command inside the
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006143 loop, execution continues after the "endfor".
Bram Moolenaar572cb562005-08-05 21:35:02 +00006144 Changing {list} inside the loop affects what items are
6145 used. Make a copy if this is unwanted: >
Bram Moolenaarde8866b2005-01-06 23:24:37 +00006146 :for item in copy(mylist)
6147< When not making a copy, Vim stores a reference to the
6148 next item in the list, before executing the commands
6149 with the current item. Thus the current item can be
6150 removed without effect. Removing any later item means
6151 it will not be found. Thus the following example
6152 works (an inefficient way to make a list empty): >
6153 :for item in mylist
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006154 :call remove(mylist, 0)
6155 :endfor
Bram Moolenaar9588a0f2005-01-08 21:45:39 +00006156< Note that reordering the list (e.g., with sort() or
6157 reverse()) may have unexpected effects.
6158 Note that the type of each list item should be
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006159 identical to avoid errors for the type of {var}
6160 changing. Unlet the variable at the end of the loop
6161 to allow multiple item types.
6162
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006163:for [{var1}, {var2}, ...] in {listlist}
6164:endfo[r]
6165 Like ":for" above, but each item in {listlist} must be
6166 a list, of which each item is assigned to {var1},
6167 {var2}, etc. Example: >
6168 :for [lnum, col] in [[1, 3], [2, 5], [3, 8]]
6169 :echo getline(lnum)[col]
6170 :endfor
6171<
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006172 *:continue* *:con* *E586*
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006173:con[tinue] When used inside a ":while" or ":for" loop, jumps back
6174 to the start of the loop.
6175 If it is used after a |:try| inside the loop but
6176 before the matching |:finally| (if present), the
6177 commands following the ":finally" up to the matching
6178 |:endtry| are executed first. This process applies to
6179 all nested ":try"s inside the loop. The outermost
6180 ":endtry" then jumps back to the start of the loop.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006181
6182 *:break* *:brea* *E587*
Bram Moolenaar12805862005-01-05 22:16:17 +00006183:brea[k] When used inside a ":while" or ":for" loop, skips to
6184 the command after the matching ":endwhile" or
6185 ":endfor".
6186 If it is used after a |:try| inside the loop but
6187 before the matching |:finally| (if present), the
6188 commands following the ":finally" up to the matching
6189 |:endtry| are executed first. This process applies to
6190 all nested ":try"s inside the loop. The outermost
6191 ":endtry" then jumps to the command after the loop.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006192
6193:try *:try* *:endt* *:endtry* *E600* *E601* *E602*
6194:endt[ry] Change the error handling for the commands between
6195 ":try" and ":endtry" including everything being
6196 executed across ":source" commands, function calls,
6197 or autocommand invocations.
6198
6199 When an error or interrupt is detected and there is
6200 a |:finally| command following, execution continues
6201 after the ":finally". Otherwise, or when the
6202 ":endtry" is reached thereafter, the next
6203 (dynamically) surrounding ":try" is checked for
6204 a corresponding ":finally" etc. Then the script
6205 processing is terminated. (Whether a function
6206 definition has an "abort" argument does not matter.)
6207 Example: >
6208 :try | edit too much | finally | echo "cleanup" | endtry
6209 :echo "impossible" " not reached, script terminated above
6210<
6211 Moreover, an error or interrupt (dynamically) inside
6212 ":try" and ":endtry" is converted to an exception. It
6213 can be caught as if it were thrown by a |:throw|
6214 command (see |:catch|). In this case, the script
6215 processing is not terminated.
6216
6217 The value "Vim:Interrupt" is used for an interrupt
6218 exception. An error in a Vim command is converted
6219 to a value of the form "Vim({command}):{errmsg}",
6220 other errors are converted to a value of the form
6221 "Vim:{errmsg}". {command} is the full command name,
6222 and {errmsg} is the message that is displayed if the
6223 error exception is not caught, always beginning with
6224 the error number.
6225 Examples: >
6226 :try | sleep 100 | catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/ | endtry
6227 :try | edit | catch /^Vim(edit):E\d\+/ | echo "error" | endtry
6228<
6229 *:cat* *:catch* *E603* *E604* *E605*
6230:cat[ch] /{pattern}/ The following commands until the next ":catch",
6231 |:finally|, or |:endtry| that belongs to the same
6232 |:try| as the ":catch" are executed when an exception
6233 matching {pattern} is being thrown and has not yet
6234 been caught by a previous ":catch". Otherwise, these
6235 commands are skipped.
6236 When {pattern} is omitted all errors are caught.
6237 Examples: >
6238 :catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/ " catch interrupts (CTRL-C)
6239 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:E/ " catch all Vim errors
6240 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:/ " catch errors and interrupts
6241 :catch /^Vim(write):/ " catch all errors in :write
6242 :catch /^Vim\%((\a\+)\)\=:E123/ " catch error E123
6243 :catch /my-exception/ " catch user exception
6244 :catch /.*/ " catch everything
6245 :catch " same as /.*/
6246<
6247 Another character can be used instead of / around the
6248 {pattern}, so long as it does not have a special
6249 meaning (e.g., '|' or '"') and doesn't occur inside
6250 {pattern}.
6251 NOTE: It is not reliable to ":catch" the TEXT of
6252 an error message because it may vary in different
6253 locales.
6254
6255 *:fina* *:finally* *E606* *E607*
6256:fina[lly] The following commands until the matching |:endtry|
6257 are executed whenever the part between the matching
6258 |:try| and the ":finally" is left: either by falling
6259 through to the ":finally" or by a |:continue|,
6260 |:break|, |:finish|, or |:return|, or by an error or
6261 interrupt or exception (see |:throw|).
6262
6263 *:th* *:throw* *E608*
6264:th[row] {expr1} The {expr1} is evaluated and thrown as an exception.
6265 If the ":throw" is used after a |:try| but before the
6266 first corresponding |:catch|, commands are skipped
6267 until the first ":catch" matching {expr1} is reached.
6268 If there is no such ":catch" or if the ":throw" is
6269 used after a ":catch" but before the |:finally|, the
6270 commands following the ":finally" (if present) up to
6271 the matching |:endtry| are executed. If the ":throw"
6272 is after the ":finally", commands up to the ":endtry"
6273 are skipped. At the ":endtry", this process applies
6274 again for the next dynamically surrounding ":try"
6275 (which may be found in a calling function or sourcing
6276 script), until a matching ":catch" has been found.
6277 If the exception is not caught, the command processing
6278 is terminated.
6279 Example: >
6280 :try | throw "oops" | catch /^oo/ | echo "caught" | endtry
6281<
6282
6283 *:ec* *:echo*
6284:ec[ho] {expr1} .. Echoes each {expr1}, with a space in between. The
6285 first {expr1} starts on a new line.
6286 Also see |:comment|.
6287 Use "\n" to start a new line. Use "\r" to move the
6288 cursor to the first column.
6289 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command.
6290 Cannot be followed by a comment.
6291 Example: >
6292 :echo "the value of 'shell' is" &shell
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00006293< *:echo-redraw*
6294 A later redraw may make the message disappear again.
6295 And since Vim mostly postpones redrawing until it's
6296 finished with a sequence of commands this happens
6297 quite often. To avoid that a command from before the
6298 ":echo" causes a redraw afterwards (redraws are often
6299 postponed until you type something), force a redraw
6300 with the |:redraw| command. Example: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006301 :new | redraw | echo "there is a new window"
6302<
6303 *:echon*
6304:echon {expr1} .. Echoes each {expr1}, without anything added. Also see
6305 |:comment|.
6306 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command.
6307 Cannot be followed by a comment.
6308 Example: >
6309 :echon "the value of 'shell' is " &shell
6310<
6311 Note the difference between using ":echo", which is a
6312 Vim command, and ":!echo", which is an external shell
6313 command: >
6314 :!echo % --> filename
6315< The arguments of ":!" are expanded, see |:_%|. >
6316 :!echo "%" --> filename or "filename"
6317< Like the previous example. Whether you see the double
6318 quotes or not depends on your 'shell'. >
6319 :echo % --> nothing
6320< The '%' is an illegal character in an expression. >
6321 :echo "%" --> %
6322< This just echoes the '%' character. >
6323 :echo expand("%") --> filename
6324< This calls the expand() function to expand the '%'.
6325
6326 *:echoh* *:echohl*
6327:echoh[l] {name} Use the highlight group {name} for the following
6328 |:echo|, |:echon| and |:echomsg| commands. Also used
6329 for the |input()| prompt. Example: >
6330 :echohl WarningMsg | echo "Don't panic!" | echohl None
6331< Don't forget to set the group back to "None",
6332 otherwise all following echo's will be highlighted.
6333
6334 *:echom* *:echomsg*
6335:echom[sg] {expr1} .. Echo the expression(s) as a true message, saving the
6336 message in the |message-history|.
6337 Spaces are placed between the arguments as with the
6338 |:echo| command. But unprintable characters are
6339 displayed, not interpreted.
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00006340 The parsing works slightly different from |:echo|,
6341 more like |:execute|. All the expressions are first
6342 evaluated and concatenated before echoing anything.
6343 The expressions must evaluate to a Number or String, a
6344 Dictionary or List causes an error.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006345 Uses the highlighting set by the |:echohl| command.
6346 Example: >
6347 :echomsg "It's a Zizzer Zazzer Zuzz, as you can plainly see."
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00006348< See |:echo-redraw| to avoid the message disappearing
6349 when the screen is redrawn.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006350 *:echoe* *:echoerr*
6351:echoe[rr] {expr1} .. Echo the expression(s) as an error message, saving the
6352 message in the |message-history|. When used in a
6353 script or function the line number will be added.
6354 Spaces are placed between the arguments as with the
6355 :echo command. When used inside a try conditional,
6356 the message is raised as an error exception instead
6357 (see |try-echoerr|).
6358 Example: >
6359 :echoerr "This script just failed!"
6360< If you just want a highlighted message use |:echohl|.
6361 And to get a beep: >
6362 :exe "normal \<Esc>"
6363<
6364 *:exe* *:execute*
6365:exe[cute] {expr1} .. Executes the string that results from the evaluation
6366 of {expr1} as an Ex command. Multiple arguments are
6367 concatenated, with a space in between. {expr1} is
6368 used as the processed command, command line editing
6369 keys are not recognized.
6370 Cannot be followed by a comment.
6371 Examples: >
6372 :execute "buffer " nextbuf
6373 :execute "normal " count . "w"
6374<
6375 ":execute" can be used to append a command to commands
6376 that don't accept a '|'. Example: >
6377 :execute '!ls' | echo "theend"
6378
6379< ":execute" is also a nice way to avoid having to type
6380 control characters in a Vim script for a ":normal"
6381 command: >
6382 :execute "normal ixxx\<Esc>"
6383< This has an <Esc> character, see |expr-string|.
6384
6385 Note: The executed string may be any command-line, but
Bram Moolenaard8b02732005-01-14 21:48:43 +00006386 you cannot start or end a "while", "for" or "if"
6387 command. Thus this is illegal: >
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00006388 :execute 'while i > 5'
6389 :execute 'echo "test" | break'
6390<
6391 It is allowed to have a "while" or "if" command
6392 completely in the executed string: >
6393 :execute 'while i < 5 | echo i | let i = i + 1 | endwhile'
6394<
6395
6396 *:comment*
6397 ":execute", ":echo" and ":echon" cannot be followed by
6398 a comment directly, because they see the '"' as the
6399 start of a string. But, you can use '|' followed by a
6400 comment. Example: >
6401 :echo "foo" | "this is a comment
6402
6403==============================================================================
64048. Exception handling *exception-handling*
6405
6406The Vim script language comprises an exception handling feature. This section
6407explains how it can be used in a Vim script.
6408
6409Exceptions may be raised by Vim on an error or on interrupt, see
6410|catch-errors| and |catch-interrupt|. You can also explicitly throw an
6411exception by using the ":throw" command, see |throw-catch|.
6412
6413
6414TRY CONDITIONALS *try-conditionals*
6415
6416Exceptions can be caught or can cause cleanup code to be executed. You can
6417use a try conditional to specify catch clauses (that catch exceptions) and/or
6418a finally clause (to be executed for cleanup).
6419 A try conditional begins with a |:try| command and ends at the matching
6420|:endtry| command. In between, you can use a |:catch| command to start
6421a catch clause, or a |:finally| command to start a finally clause. There may
6422be none or multiple catch clauses, but there is at most one finally clause,
6423which must not be followed by any catch clauses. The lines before the catch
6424clauses and the finally clause is called a try block. >
6425
6426 :try
6427 : ...
6428 : ... TRY BLOCK
6429 : ...
6430 :catch /{pattern}/
6431 : ...
6432 : ... CATCH CLAUSE
6433 : ...
6434 :catch /{pattern}/
6435 : ...
6436 : ... CATCH CLAUSE
6437 : ...
6438 :finally
6439 : ...
6440 : ... FINALLY CLAUSE
6441 : ...
6442 :endtry
6443
6444The try conditional allows to watch code for exceptions and to take the
6445appropriate actions. Exceptions from the try block may be caught. Exceptions
6446from the try block and also the catch clauses may cause cleanup actions.
6447 When no exception is thrown during execution of the try block, the control
6448is transferred to the finally clause, if present. After its execution, the
6449script continues with the line following the ":endtry".
6450 When an exception occurs during execution of the try block, the remaining
6451lines in the try block are skipped. The exception is matched against the
6452patterns specified as arguments to the ":catch" commands. The catch clause
6453after the first matching ":catch" is taken, other catch clauses are not
6454executed. The catch clause ends when the next ":catch", ":finally", or
6455":endtry" command is reached - whatever is first. Then, the finally clause
6456(if present) is executed. When the ":endtry" is reached, the script execution
6457continues in the following line as usual.
6458 When an exception that does not match any of the patterns specified by the
6459":catch" commands is thrown in the try block, the exception is not caught by
6460that try conditional and none of the catch clauses is executed. Only the
6461finally clause, if present, is taken. The exception pends during execution of
6462the finally clause. It is resumed at the ":endtry", so that commands after
6463the ":endtry" are not executed and the exception might be caught elsewhere,
6464see |try-nesting|.
6465 When during execution of a catch clause another exception is thrown, the
6466remaining lines in that catch clause are not executed. The new exception is
6467not matched against the patterns in any of the ":catch" commands of the same
6468try conditional and none of its catch clauses is taken. If there is, however,
6469a finally clause, it is executed, and the exception pends during its
6470execution. The commands following the ":endtry" are not executed. The new
6471exception might, however, be caught elsewhere, see |try-nesting|.
6472 When during execution of the finally clause (if present) an exception is
6473thrown, the remaining lines in the finally clause are skipped. If the finally
6474clause has been taken because of an exception from the try block or one of the
6475catch clauses, the original (pending) exception is discarded. The commands
6476following the ":endtry" are not executed, and the exception from the finally
6477clause is propagated and can be caught elsewhere, see |try-nesting|.
6478
6479The finally clause is also executed, when a ":break" or ":continue" for
6480a ":while" loop enclosing the complete try conditional is executed from the
6481try block or a catch clause. Or when a ":return" or ":finish" is executed
6482from the try block or a catch clause of a try conditional in a function or
6483sourced script, respectively. The ":break", ":continue", ":return", or
6484":finish" pends during execution of the finally clause and is resumed when the
6485":endtry" is reached. It is, however, discarded when an exception is thrown
6486from the finally clause.
6487 When a ":break" or ":continue" for a ":while" loop enclosing the complete
6488try conditional or when a ":return" or ":finish" is encountered in the finally
6489clause, the rest of the finally clause is skipped, and the ":break",
6490":continue", ":return" or ":finish" is executed as usual. If the finally
6491clause has been taken because of an exception or an earlier ":break",
6492":continue", ":return", or ":finish" from the try block or a catch clause,
6493this pending exception or command is discarded.
6494
6495For examples see |throw-catch| and |try-finally|.
6496
6497
6498NESTING OF TRY CONDITIONALS *try-nesting*
6499
6500Try conditionals can be nested arbitrarily. That is, a complete try
6501conditional can be put into the try block, a catch clause, or the finally
6502clause of another try conditional. If the inner try conditional does not
6503catch an exception thrown in its try block or throws a new exception from one
6504of its catch clauses or its finally clause, the outer try conditional is
6505checked according to the rules above. If the inner try conditional is in the
6506try block of the outer try conditional, its catch clauses are checked, but
6507otherwise only the finally clause is executed. It does not matter for
6508nesting, whether the inner try conditional is directly contained in the outer
6509one, or whether the outer one sources a script or calls a function containing
6510the inner try conditional.
6511
6512When none of the active try conditionals catches an exception, just their
6513finally clauses are executed. Thereafter, the script processing terminates.
6514An error message is displayed in case of an uncaught exception explicitly
6515thrown by a ":throw" command. For uncaught error and interrupt exceptions
6516implicitly raised by Vim, the error message(s) or interrupt message are shown
6517as usual.
6518
6519For examples see |throw-catch|.
6520
6521
6522EXAMINING EXCEPTION HANDLING CODE *except-examine*
6523
6524Exception handling code can get tricky. If you are in doubt what happens, set
6525'verbose' to 13 or use the ":13verbose" command modifier when sourcing your
6526script file. Then you see when an exception is thrown, discarded, caught, or
6527finished. When using a verbosity level of at least 14, things pending in
6528a finally clause are also shown. This information is also given in debug mode
6529(see |debug-scripts|).
6530
6531
6532THROWING AND CATCHING EXCEPTIONS *throw-catch*
6533
6534You can throw any number or string as an exception. Use the |:throw| command
6535and pass the value to be thrown as argument: >
6536 :throw 4711
6537 :throw "string"
6538< *throw-expression*
6539You can also specify an expression argument. The expression is then evaluated
6540first, and the result is thrown: >
6541 :throw 4705 + strlen("string")
6542 :throw strpart("strings", 0, 6)
6543
6544An exception might be thrown during evaluation of the argument of the ":throw"
6545command. Unless it is caught there, the expression evaluation is abandoned.
6546The ":throw" command then does not throw a new exception.
6547 Example: >
6548
6549 :function! Foo(arg)
6550 : try
6551 : throw a:arg
6552 : catch /foo/
6553 : endtry
6554 : return 1
6555 :endfunction
6556 :
6557 :function! Bar()
6558 : echo "in Bar"
6559 : return 4710
6560 :endfunction
6561 :
6562 :throw Foo("arrgh") + Bar()
6563
6564This throws "arrgh", and "in Bar" is not displayed since Bar() is not
6565executed. >
6566 :throw Foo("foo") + Bar()
6567however displays "in Bar" and throws 4711.
6568
6569Any other command that takes an expression as argument might also be
6570abandoned by an (uncaught) exception during the expression evaluation. The
6571exception is then propagated to the caller of the command.
6572 Example: >
6573
6574 :if Foo("arrgh")
6575 : echo "then"
6576 :else
6577 : echo "else"
6578 :endif
6579
6580Here neither of "then" or "else" is displayed.
6581
6582 *catch-order*
6583Exceptions can be caught by a try conditional with one or more |:catch|
6584commands, see |try-conditionals|. The values to be caught by each ":catch"
6585command can be specified as a pattern argument. The subsequent catch clause
6586gets executed when a matching exception is caught.
6587 Example: >
6588
6589 :function! Foo(value)
6590 : try
6591 : throw a:value
6592 : catch /^\d\+$/
6593 : echo "Number thrown"
6594 : catch /.*/
6595 : echo "String thrown"
6596 : endtry
6597 :endfunction
6598 :
6599 :call Foo(0x1267)
6600 :call Foo('string')
6601
6602The first call to Foo() displays "Number thrown", the second "String thrown".
6603An exception is matched against the ":catch" commands in the order they are
6604specified. Only the first match counts. So you should place the more
6605specific ":catch" first. The following order does not make sense: >
6606
6607 : catch /.*/
6608 : echo "String thrown"
6609 : catch /^\d\+$/
6610 : echo "Number thrown"
6611
6612The first ":catch" here matches always, so that the second catch clause is
6613never taken.
6614
6615 *throw-variables*
6616If you catch an exception by a general pattern, you may access the exact value
6617in the variable |v:exception|: >
6618
6619 : catch /^\d\+$/
6620 : echo "Number thrown. Value is" v:exception
6621
6622You may also be interested where an exception was thrown. This is stored in
6623|v:throwpoint|. Note that "v:exception" and "v:throwpoint" are valid for the
6624exception most recently caught as long it is not finished.
6625 Example: >
6626
6627 :function! Caught()
6628 : if v:exception != ""
6629 : echo 'Caught "' . v:exception . '" in ' . v:throwpoint
6630 : else
6631 : echo 'Nothing caught'
6632 : endif
6633 :endfunction
6634 :
6635 :function! Foo()
6636 : try
6637 : try
6638 : try
6639 : throw 4711
6640 : finally
6641 : call Caught()
6642 : endtry
6643 : catch /.*/
6644 : call Caught()
6645 : throw "oops"
6646 : endtry
6647 : catch /.*/
6648 : call Caught()
6649 : finally
6650 : call Caught()
6651 : endtry
6652 :endfunction
6653 :
6654 :call Foo()
6655
6656This displays >
6657
6658 Nothing caught
6659 Caught "4711" in function Foo, line 4
6660 Caught "oops" in function Foo, line 10
6661 Nothing caught
6662
6663A practical example: The following command ":LineNumber" displays the line
6664number in the script or function where it has been used: >
6665
6666 :function! LineNumber()
6667 : return substitute(v:throwpoint, '.*\D\(\d\+\).*', '\1', "")
6668 :endfunction
6669 :command! LineNumber try | throw "" | catch | echo LineNumber() | endtry
6670<
6671 *try-nested*
6672An exception that is not caught by a try conditional can be caught by
6673a surrounding try conditional: >
6674
6675 :try
6676 : try
6677 : throw "foo"
6678 : catch /foobar/
6679 : echo "foobar"
6680 : finally
6681 : echo "inner finally"
6682 : endtry
6683 :catch /foo/
6684 : echo "foo"
6685 :endtry
6686
6687The inner try conditional does not catch the exception, just its finally
6688clause is executed. The exception is then caught by the outer try
6689conditional. The example displays "inner finally" and then "foo".
6690
6691 *throw-from-catch*
6692You can catch an exception and throw a new one to be caught elsewhere from the
6693catch clause: >
6694
6695 :function! Foo()
6696 : throw "foo"
6697 :endfunction
6698 :
6699 :function! Bar()
6700 : try
6701 : call Foo()
6702 : catch /foo/
6703 : echo "Caught foo, throw bar"
6704 : throw "bar"
6705 : endtry
6706 :endfunction
6707 :
6708 :try
6709 : call Bar()
6710 :catch /.*/
6711 : echo "Caught" v:exception
6712 :endtry
6713
6714This displays "Caught foo, throw bar" and then "Caught bar".
6715
6716 *rethrow*
6717There is no real rethrow in the Vim script language, but you may throw
6718"v:exception" instead: >
6719
6720 :function! Bar()
6721 : try
6722 : call Foo()
6723 : catch /.*/
6724 : echo "Rethrow" v:exception
6725 : throw v:exception
6726 : endtry
6727 :endfunction
6728< *try-echoerr*
6729Note that this method cannot be used to "rethrow" Vim error or interrupt
6730exceptions, because it is not possible to fake Vim internal exceptions.
6731Trying so causes an error exception. You should throw your own exception
6732denoting the situation. If you want to cause a Vim error exception containing
6733the original error exception value, you can use the |:echoerr| command: >
6734
6735 :try
6736 : try
6737 : asdf
6738 : catch /.*/
6739 : echoerr v:exception
6740 : endtry
6741 :catch /.*/
6742 : echo v:exception
6743 :endtry
6744
6745This code displays
6746
6747 Vim(echoerr):Vim:E492: Not an editor command: asdf ~
6748
6749
6750CLEANUP CODE *try-finally*
6751
6752Scripts often change global settings and restore them at their end. If the
6753user however interrupts the script by pressing CTRL-C, the settings remain in
6754an inconsistent state. The same may happen to you in the development phase of
6755a script when an error occurs or you explicitly throw an exception without
6756catching it. You can solve these problems by using a try conditional with
6757a finally clause for restoring the settings. Its execution is guaranteed on
6758normal control flow, on error, on an explicit ":throw", and on interrupt.
6759(Note that errors and interrupts from inside the try conditional are converted
6760to exceptions. When not caught, they terminate the script after the finally
6761clause has been executed.)
6762Example: >
6763
6764 :try
6765 : let s:saved_ts = &ts
6766 : set ts=17
6767 :
6768 : " Do the hard work here.
6769 :
6770 :finally
6771 : let &ts = s:saved_ts
6772 : unlet s:saved_ts
6773 :endtry
6774
6775This method should be used locally whenever a function or part of a script
6776changes global settings which need to be restored on failure or normal exit of
6777that function or script part.
6778
6779 *break-finally*
6780Cleanup code works also when the try block or a catch clause is left by
6781a ":continue", ":break", ":return", or ":finish".
6782 Example: >
6783
6784 :let first = 1
6785 :while 1
6786 : try
6787 : if first
6788 : echo "first"
6789 : let first = 0
6790 : continue
6791 : else
6792 : throw "second"
6793 : endif
6794 : catch /.*/
6795 : echo v:exception
6796 : break
6797 : finally
6798 : echo "cleanup"
6799 : endtry
6800 : echo "still in while"
6801 :endwhile
6802 :echo "end"
6803
6804This displays "first", "cleanup", "second", "cleanup", and "end". >
6805
6806 :function! Foo()
6807 : try
6808 : return 4711
6809 : finally
6810 : echo "cleanup\n"
6811 : endtry
6812 : echo "Foo still active"
6813 :endfunction
6814 :
6815 :echo Foo() "returned by Foo"
6816
6817This displays "cleanup" and "4711 returned by Foo". You don't need to add an
6818extra ":return" in the finally clause. (Above all, this would override the
6819return value.)
6820
6821 *except-from-finally*
6822Using either of ":continue", ":break", ":return", ":finish", or ":throw" in
6823a finally clause is possible, but not recommended since it abandons the
6824cleanup actions for the try conditional. But, of course, interrupt and error
6825exceptions might get raised from a finally clause.
6826 Example where an error in the finally clause stops an interrupt from
6827working correctly: >
6828
6829 :try
6830 : try
6831 : echo "Press CTRL-C for interrupt"
6832 : while 1
6833 : endwhile
6834 : finally
6835 : unlet novar
6836 : endtry
6837 :catch /novar/
6838 :endtry
6839 :echo "Script still running"
6840 :sleep 1
6841
6842If you need to put commands that could fail into a finally clause, you should
6843think about catching or ignoring the errors in these commands, see
6844|catch-errors| and |ignore-errors|.
6845
6846
6847CATCHING ERRORS *catch-errors*
6848
6849If you want to catch specific errors, you just have to put the code to be
6850watched in a try block and add a catch clause for the error message. The
6851presence of the try conditional causes all errors to be converted to an
6852exception. No message is displayed and |v:errmsg| is not set then. To find
6853the right pattern for the ":catch" command, you have to know how the format of
6854the error exception is.
6855 Error exceptions have the following format: >
6856
6857 Vim({cmdname}):{errmsg}
6858or >
6859 Vim:{errmsg}
6860
6861{cmdname} is the name of the command that failed; the second form is used when
6862the command name is not known. {errmsg} is the error message usually produced
6863when the error occurs outside try conditionals. It always begins with
6864a capital "E", followed by a two or three-digit error number, a colon, and
6865a space.
6866
6867Examples:
6868
6869The command >
6870 :unlet novar
6871normally produces the error message >
6872 E108: No such variable: "novar"
6873which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception >
6874 Vim(unlet):E108: No such variable: "novar"
6875
6876The command >
6877 :dwim
6878normally produces the error message >
6879 E492: Not an editor command: dwim
6880which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception >
6881 Vim:E492: Not an editor command: dwim
6882
6883You can catch all ":unlet" errors by a >
6884 :catch /^Vim(unlet):/
6885or all errors for misspelled command names by a >
6886 :catch /^Vim:E492:/
6887
6888Some error messages may be produced by different commands: >
6889 :function nofunc
6890and >
6891 :delfunction nofunc
6892both produce the error message >
6893 E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc
6894which is converted inside try conditionals to an exception >
6895 Vim(function):E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc
6896or >
6897 Vim(delfunction):E128: Function name must start with a capital: nofunc
6898respectively. You can catch the error by its number independently on the
6899command that caused it if you use the following pattern: >
6900 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E128:/
6901
6902Some commands like >
6903 :let x = novar
6904produce multiple error messages, here: >
6905 E121: Undefined variable: novar
6906 E15: Invalid expression: novar
6907Only the first is used for the exception value, since it is the most specific
6908one (see |except-several-errors|). So you can catch it by >
6909 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E121:/
6910
6911You can catch all errors related to the name "nofunc" by >
6912 :catch /\<nofunc\>/
6913
6914You can catch all Vim errors in the ":write" and ":read" commands by >
6915 :catch /^Vim(\(write\|read\)):E\d\+:/
6916
6917You can catch all Vim errors by the pattern >
6918 :catch /^Vim\((\a\+)\)\=:E\d\+:/
6919<
6920 *catch-text*
6921NOTE: You should never catch the error message text itself: >
6922 :catch /No such variable/
6923only works in the english locale, but not when the user has selected
6924a different language by the |:language| command. It is however helpful to
6925cite the message text in a comment: >
6926 :catch /^Vim(\a\+):E108:/ " No such variable
6927
6928
6929IGNORING ERRORS *ignore-errors*
6930
6931You can ignore errors in a specific Vim command by catching them locally: >
6932
6933 :try
6934 : write
6935 :catch
6936 :endtry
6937
6938But you are strongly recommended NOT to use this simple form, since it could
6939catch more than you want. With the ":write" command, some autocommands could
6940be executed and cause errors not related to writing, for instance: >
6941
6942 :au BufWritePre * unlet novar
6943
6944There could even be such errors you are not responsible for as a script
6945writer: a user of your script might have defined such autocommands. You would
6946then hide the error from the user.
6947 It is much better to use >
6948
6949 :try
6950 : write
6951 :catch /^Vim(write):/
6952 :endtry
6953
6954which only catches real write errors. So catch only what you'd like to ignore
6955intentionally.
6956
6957For a single command that does not cause execution of autocommands, you could
6958even suppress the conversion of errors to exceptions by the ":silent!"
6959command: >
6960 :silent! nunmap k
6961This works also when a try conditional is active.
6962
6963
6964CATCHING INTERRUPTS *catch-interrupt*
6965
6966When there are active try conditionals, an interrupt (CTRL-C) is converted to
6967the exception "Vim:Interrupt". You can catch it like every exception. The
6968script is not terminated, then.
6969 Example: >
6970
6971 :function! TASK1()
6972 : sleep 10
6973 :endfunction
6974
6975 :function! TASK2()
6976 : sleep 20
6977 :endfunction
6978
6979 :while 1
6980 : let command = input("Type a command: ")
6981 : try
6982 : if command == ""
6983 : continue
6984 : elseif command == "END"
6985 : break
6986 : elseif command == "TASK1"
6987 : call TASK1()
6988 : elseif command == "TASK2"
6989 : call TASK2()
6990 : else
6991 : echo "\nIllegal command:" command
6992 : continue
6993 : endif
6994 : catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/
6995 : echo "\nCommand interrupted"
6996 : " Caught the interrupt. Continue with next prompt.
6997 : endtry
6998 :endwhile
6999
7000You can interrupt a task here by pressing CTRL-C; the script then asks for
7001a new command. If you press CTRL-C at the prompt, the script is terminated.
7002
7003For testing what happens when CTRL-C would be pressed on a specific line in
7004your script, use the debug mode and execute the |>quit| or |>interrupt|
7005command on that line. See |debug-scripts|.
7006
7007
7008CATCHING ALL *catch-all*
7009
7010The commands >
7011
7012 :catch /.*/
7013 :catch //
7014 :catch
7015
7016catch everything, error exceptions, interrupt exceptions and exceptions
7017explicitly thrown by the |:throw| command. This is useful at the top level of
7018a script in order to catch unexpected things.
7019 Example: >
7020
7021 :try
7022 :
7023 : " do the hard work here
7024 :
7025 :catch /MyException/
7026 :
7027 : " handle known problem
7028 :
7029 :catch /^Vim:Interrupt$/
7030 : echo "Script interrupted"
7031 :catch /.*/
7032 : echo "Internal error (" . v:exception . ")"
7033 : echo " - occurred at " . v:throwpoint
7034 :endtry
7035 :" end of script
7036
7037Note: Catching all might catch more things than you want. Thus, you are
7038strongly encouraged to catch only for problems that you can really handle by
7039specifying a pattern argument to the ":catch".
7040 Example: Catching all could make it nearly impossible to interrupt a script
7041by pressing CTRL-C: >
7042
7043 :while 1
7044 : try
7045 : sleep 1
7046 : catch
7047 : endtry
7048 :endwhile
7049
7050
7051EXCEPTIONS AND AUTOCOMMANDS *except-autocmd*
7052
7053Exceptions may be used during execution of autocommands. Example: >
7054
7055 :autocmd User x try
7056 :autocmd User x throw "Oops!"
7057 :autocmd User x catch
7058 :autocmd User x echo v:exception
7059 :autocmd User x endtry
7060 :autocmd User x throw "Arrgh!"
7061 :autocmd User x echo "Should not be displayed"
7062 :
7063 :try
7064 : doautocmd User x
7065 :catch
7066 : echo v:exception
7067 :endtry
7068
7069This displays "Oops!" and "Arrgh!".
7070
7071 *except-autocmd-Pre*
7072For some commands, autocommands get executed before the main action of the
7073command takes place. If an exception is thrown and not caught in the sequence
7074of autocommands, the sequence and the command that caused its execution are
7075abandoned and the exception is propagated to the caller of the command.
7076 Example: >
7077
7078 :autocmd BufWritePre * throw "FAIL"
7079 :autocmd BufWritePre * echo "Should not be displayed"
7080 :
7081 :try
7082 : write
7083 :catch
7084 : echo "Caught:" v:exception "from" v:throwpoint
7085 :endtry
7086
7087Here, the ":write" command does not write the file currently being edited (as
7088you can see by checking 'modified'), since the exception from the BufWritePre
7089autocommand abandons the ":write". The exception is then caught and the
7090script displays: >
7091
7092 Caught: FAIL from BufWrite Auto commands for "*"
7093<
7094 *except-autocmd-Post*
7095For some commands, autocommands get executed after the main action of the
7096command has taken place. If this main action fails and the command is inside
7097an active try conditional, the autocommands are skipped and an error exception
7098is thrown that can be caught by the caller of the command.
7099 Example: >
7100
7101 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo "File successfully written!"
7102 :
7103 :try
7104 : write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
7105 :catch
7106 : echo v:exception
7107 :endtry
7108
7109This just displays: >
7110
7111 Vim(write):E212: Can't open file for writing (/i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e)
7112
7113If you really need to execute the autocommands even when the main action
7114fails, trigger the event from the catch clause.
7115 Example: >
7116
7117 :autocmd BufWritePre * set noreadonly
7118 :autocmd BufWritePost * set readonly
7119 :
7120 :try
7121 : write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
7122 :catch
7123 : doautocmd BufWritePost /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
7124 :endtry
7125<
7126You can also use ":silent!": >
7127
7128 :let x = "ok"
7129 :let v:errmsg = ""
7130 :autocmd BufWritePost * if v:errmsg != ""
7131 :autocmd BufWritePost * let x = "after fail"
7132 :autocmd BufWritePost * endif
7133 :try
7134 : silent! write /i/m/p/o/s/s/i/b/l/e
7135 :catch
7136 :endtry
7137 :echo x
7138
7139This displays "after fail".
7140
7141If the main action of the command does not fail, exceptions from the
7142autocommands will be catchable by the caller of the command: >
7143
7144 :autocmd BufWritePost * throw ":-("
7145 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo "Should not be displayed"
7146 :
7147 :try
7148 : write
7149 :catch
7150 : echo v:exception
7151 :endtry
7152<
7153 *except-autocmd-Cmd*
7154For some commands, the normal action can be replaced by a sequence of
7155autocommands. Exceptions from that sequence will be catchable by the caller
7156of the command.
7157 Example: For the ":write" command, the caller cannot know whether the file
7158had actually been written when the exception occurred. You need to tell it in
7159some way. >
7160
7161 :if !exists("cnt")
7162 : let cnt = 0
7163 :
7164 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if &modified
7165 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * let cnt = cnt + 1
7166 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if cnt % 3 == 2
7167 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * throw "BufWriteCmdError"
7168 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif
7169 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * write | set nomodified
7170 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * if cnt % 3 == 0
7171 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * throw "BufWriteCmdError"
7172 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif
7173 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * echo "File successfully written!"
7174 : autocmd BufWriteCmd * endif
7175 :endif
7176 :
7177 :try
7178 : write
7179 :catch /^BufWriteCmdError$/
7180 : if &modified
7181 : echo "Error on writing (file contents not changed)"
7182 : else
7183 : echo "Error after writing"
7184 : endif
7185 :catch /^Vim(write):/
7186 : echo "Error on writing"
7187 :endtry
7188
7189When this script is sourced several times after making changes, it displays
7190first >
7191 File successfully written!
7192then >
7193 Error on writing (file contents not changed)
7194then >
7195 Error after writing
7196etc.
7197
7198 *except-autocmd-ill*
7199You cannot spread a try conditional over autocommands for different events.
7200The following code is ill-formed: >
7201
7202 :autocmd BufWritePre * try
7203 :
7204 :autocmd BufWritePost * catch
7205 :autocmd BufWritePost * echo v:exception
7206 :autocmd BufWritePost * endtry
7207 :
7208 :write
7209
7210
7211EXCEPTION HIERARCHIES AND PARAMETERIZED EXCEPTIONS *except-hier-param*
7212
7213Some programming languages allow to use hierarchies of exception classes or to
7214pass additional information with the object of an exception class. You can do
7215similar things in Vim.
7216 In order to throw an exception from a hierarchy, just throw the complete
7217class name with the components separated by a colon, for instance throw the
7218string "EXCEPT:MATHERR:OVERFLOW" for an overflow in a mathematical library.
7219 When you want to pass additional information with your exception class, add
7220it in parentheses, for instance throw the string "EXCEPT:IO:WRITEERR(myfile)"
7221for an error when writing "myfile".
7222 With the appropriate patterns in the ":catch" command, you can catch for
7223base classes or derived classes of your hierarchy. Additional information in
7224parentheses can be cut out from |v:exception| with the ":substitute" command.
7225 Example: >
7226
7227 :function! CheckRange(a, func)
7228 : if a:a < 0
7229 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:RANGE(" . a:func . ")"
7230 : endif
7231 :endfunction
7232 :
7233 :function! Add(a, b)
7234 : call CheckRange(a:a, "Add")
7235 : call CheckRange(a:b, "Add")
7236 : let c = a:a + a:b
7237 : if c < 0
7238 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:OVERFLOW"
7239 : endif
7240 : return c
7241 :endfunction
7242 :
7243 :function! Div(a, b)
7244 : call CheckRange(a:a, "Div")
7245 : call CheckRange(a:b, "Div")
7246 : if (a:b == 0)
7247 : throw "EXCEPT:MATHERR:ZERODIV"
7248 : endif
7249 : return a:a / a:b
7250 :endfunction
7251 :
7252 :function! Write(file)
7253 : try
7254 : execute "write" a:file
7255 : catch /^Vim(write):/
7256 : throw "EXCEPT:IO(" . getcwd() . ", " . a:file . "):WRITEERR"
7257 : endtry
7258 :endfunction
7259 :
7260 :try
7261 :
7262 : " something with arithmetics and I/O
7263 :
7264 :catch /^EXCEPT:MATHERR:RANGE/
7265 : let function = substitute(v:exception, '.*(\(\a\+\)).*', '\1', "")
7266 : echo "Range error in" function
7267 :
7268 :catch /^EXCEPT:MATHERR/ " catches OVERFLOW and ZERODIV
7269 : echo "Math error"
7270 :
7271 :catch /^EXCEPT:IO/
7272 : let dir = substitute(v:exception, '.*(\(.\+\),\s*.\+).*', '\1', "")
7273 : let file = substitute(v:exception, '.*(.\+,\s*\(.\+\)).*', '\1', "")
7274 : if file !~ '^/'
7275 : let file = dir . "/" . file
7276 : endif
7277 : echo 'I/O error for "' . file . '"'
7278 :
7279 :catch /^EXCEPT/
7280 : echo "Unspecified error"
7281 :
7282 :endtry
7283
7284The exceptions raised by Vim itself (on error or when pressing CTRL-C) use
7285a flat hierarchy: they are all in the "Vim" class. You cannot throw yourself
7286exceptions with the "Vim" prefix; they are reserved for Vim.
7287 Vim error exceptions are parameterized with the name of the command that
7288failed, if known. See |catch-errors|.
7289
7290
7291PECULIARITIES
7292 *except-compat*
7293The exception handling concept requires that the command sequence causing the
7294exception is aborted immediately and control is transferred to finally clauses
7295and/or a catch clause.
7296
7297In the Vim script language there are cases where scripts and functions
7298continue after an error: in functions without the "abort" flag or in a command
7299after ":silent!", control flow goes to the following line, and outside
7300functions, control flow goes to the line following the outermost ":endwhile"
7301or ":endif". On the other hand, errors should be catchable as exceptions
7302(thus, requiring the immediate abortion).
7303
7304This problem has been solved by converting errors to exceptions and using
7305immediate abortion (if not suppressed by ":silent!") only when a try
7306conditional is active. This is no restriction since an (error) exception can
7307be caught only from an active try conditional. If you want an immediate
7308termination without catching the error, just use a try conditional without
7309catch clause. (You can cause cleanup code being executed before termination
7310by specifying a finally clause.)
7311
7312When no try conditional is active, the usual abortion and continuation
7313behavior is used instead of immediate abortion. This ensures compatibility of
7314scripts written for Vim 6.1 and earlier.
7315
7316However, when sourcing an existing script that does not use exception handling
7317commands (or when calling one of its functions) from inside an active try
7318conditional of a new script, you might change the control flow of the existing
7319script on error. You get the immediate abortion on error and can catch the
7320error in the new script. If however the sourced script suppresses error
7321messages by using the ":silent!" command (checking for errors by testing
7322|v:errmsg| if appropriate), its execution path is not changed. The error is
7323not converted to an exception. (See |:silent|.) So the only remaining cause
7324where this happens is for scripts that don't care about errors and produce
7325error messages. You probably won't want to use such code from your new
7326scripts.
7327
7328 *except-syntax-err*
7329Syntax errors in the exception handling commands are never caught by any of
7330the ":catch" commands of the try conditional they belong to. Its finally
7331clauses, however, is executed.
7332 Example: >
7333
7334 :try
7335 : try
7336 : throw 4711
7337 : catch /\(/
7338 : echo "in catch with syntax error"
7339 : catch
7340 : echo "inner catch-all"
7341 : finally
7342 : echo "inner finally"
7343 : endtry
7344 :catch
7345 : echo 'outer catch-all caught "' . v:exception . '"'
7346 : finally
7347 : echo "outer finally"
7348 :endtry
7349
7350This displays: >
7351 inner finally
7352 outer catch-all caught "Vim(catch):E54: Unmatched \("
7353 outer finally
7354The original exception is discarded and an error exception is raised, instead.
7355
7356 *except-single-line*
7357The ":try", ":catch", ":finally", and ":endtry" commands can be put on
7358a single line, but then syntax errors may make it difficult to recognize the
7359"catch" line, thus you better avoid this.
7360 Example: >
7361 :try | unlet! foo # | catch | endtry
7362raises an error exception for the trailing characters after the ":unlet!"
7363argument, but does not see the ":catch" and ":endtry" commands, so that the
7364error exception is discarded and the "E488: Trailing characters" message gets
7365displayed.
7366
7367 *except-several-errors*
7368When several errors appear in a single command, the first error message is
7369usually the most specific one and therefor converted to the error exception.
7370 Example: >
7371 echo novar
7372causes >
7373 E121: Undefined variable: novar
7374 E15: Invalid expression: novar
7375The value of the error exception inside try conditionals is: >
7376 Vim(echo):E121: Undefined variable: novar
7377< *except-syntax-error*
7378But when a syntax error is detected after a normal error in the same command,
7379the syntax error is used for the exception being thrown.
7380 Example: >
7381 unlet novar #
7382causes >
7383 E108: No such variable: "novar"
7384 E488: Trailing characters
7385The value of the error exception inside try conditionals is: >
7386 Vim(unlet):E488: Trailing characters
7387This is done because the syntax error might change the execution path in a way
7388not intended by the user. Example: >
7389 try
7390 try | unlet novar # | catch | echo v:exception | endtry
7391 catch /.*/
7392 echo "outer catch:" v:exception
7393 endtry
7394This displays "outer catch: Vim(unlet):E488: Trailing characters", and then
7395a "E600: Missing :endtry" error message is given, see |except-single-line|.
7396
7397==============================================================================
73989. Examples *eval-examples*
7399
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007400Printing in Binary ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007401>
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007402 :" The function Nr2Bin() returns the Hex string of a number.
7403 :func Nr2Bin(nr)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007404 : let n = a:nr
7405 : let r = ""
7406 : while n
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007407 : let r = '01'[n % 2] . r
7408 : let n = n / 2
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007409 : endwhile
7410 : return r
7411 :endfunc
7412
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007413 :" The function String2Bin() converts each character in a string to a
7414 :" binary string, separated with dashes.
7415 :func String2Bin(str)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007416 : let out = ''
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007417 : for ix in range(strlen(a:str))
7418 : let out = out . '-' . Nr2Bin(char2nr(a:str[ix]))
7419 : endfor
7420 : return out[1:]
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007421 :endfunc
7422
7423Example of its use: >
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007424 :echo Nr2Bin(32)
7425result: "100000" >
7426 :echo String2Bin("32")
7427result: "110011-110010"
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007428
7429
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007430Sorting lines ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007431
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007432This example sorts lines with a specific compare function. >
7433
7434 :func SortBuffer()
7435 : let lines = getline(1, '$')
7436 : call sort(lines, function("Strcmp"))
7437 : call setline(1, lines)
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007438 :endfunction
7439
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007440As a one-liner: >
7441 :call setline(1, sort(getline(1, '$'), function("Strcmp")))
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007442
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007443
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007444scanf() replacement ~
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007445 *sscanf*
7446There is no sscanf() function in Vim. If you need to extract parts from a
7447line, you can use matchstr() and substitute() to do it. This example shows
7448how to get the file name, line number and column number out of a line like
7449"foobar.txt, 123, 45". >
7450 :" Set up the match bit
7451 :let mx='\(\f\+\),\s*\(\d\+\),\s*\(\d\+\)'
7452 :"get the part matching the whole expression
7453 :let l = matchstr(line, mx)
7454 :"get each item out of the match
7455 :let file = substitute(l, mx, '\1', '')
7456 :let lnum = substitute(l, mx, '\2', '')
7457 :let col = substitute(l, mx, '\3', '')
7458
7459The input is in the variable "line", the results in the variables "file",
7460"lnum" and "col". (idea from Michael Geddes)
7461
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007462
7463getting the scriptnames in a Dictionary ~
7464 *scriptnames-dictionary*
7465The |:scriptnames| command can be used to get a list of all script files that
7466have been sourced. There is no equivalent function or variable for this
7467(because it's rarely needed). In case you need to manipulate the list this
7468code can be used: >
7469 " Get the output of ":scriptnames" in the scriptnames_output variable.
7470 let scriptnames_output = ''
7471 redir => scriptnames_output
7472 silent scriptnames
7473 redir END
7474
7475 " Split the output into lines and parse each line. Add an entry to the
7476 " "scripts" dictionary.
7477 let scripts = {}
7478 for line in split(scriptnames_output, "\n")
7479 " Only do non-blank lines.
7480 if line =~ '\S'
7481 " Get the first number in the line.
7482 let nr = matchstr(line, '\d\+')
7483 " Get the file name, remove the script number " 123: ".
7484 let name = substitute(line, '.\+:\s*', '', '')
7485 " Add an item to the Dictionary
7486 let scripts[nr] = name
7487 endif
7488 endfor
7489 unlet scriptnames_output
7490
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007491==============================================================================
749210. No +eval feature *no-eval-feature*
7493
7494When the |+eval| feature was disabled at compile time, none of the expression
7495evaluation commands are available. To prevent this from causing Vim scripts
7496to generate all kinds of errors, the ":if" and ":endif" commands are still
7497recognized, though the argument of the ":if" and everything between the ":if"
7498and the matching ":endif" is ignored. Nesting of ":if" blocks is allowed, but
7499only if the commands are at the start of the line. The ":else" command is not
7500recognized.
7501
7502Example of how to avoid executing commands when the |+eval| feature is
7503missing: >
7504
7505 :if 1
7506 : echo "Expression evaluation is compiled in"
7507 :else
7508 : echo "You will _never_ see this message"
7509 :endif
7510
7511==============================================================================
751211. The sandbox *eval-sandbox* *sandbox* *E48*
7513
7514The 'foldexpr', 'includeexpr', 'indentexpr', 'statusline' and 'foldtext'
7515options are evaluated in a sandbox. This means that you are protected from
7516these expressions having nasty side effects. This gives some safety for when
7517these options are set from a modeline. It is also used when the command from
Bram Moolenaarebefac62005-12-28 22:39:57 +00007518a tags file is executed and for CTRL-R = in the command line.
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00007519The sandbox is also used for the |:sandbox| command.
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007520
7521These items are not allowed in the sandbox:
7522 - changing the buffer text
7523 - defining or changing mapping, autocommands, functions, user commands
7524 - setting certain options (see |option-summary|)
Bram Moolenaaref2f6562007-05-06 13:32:59 +00007525 - setting certain v: variables (see |v:var|) *E794*
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007526 - executing a shell command
7527 - reading or writing a file
7528 - jumping to another buffer or editing a file
Bram Moolenaar4770d092006-01-12 23:22:24 +00007529 - executing Python, Perl, etc. commands
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00007530This is not guaranteed 100% secure, but it should block most attacks.
7531
7532 *:san* *:sandbox*
Bram Moolenaar045e82d2005-07-08 22:25:33 +00007533:san[dbox] {cmd} Execute {cmd} in the sandbox. Useful to evaluate an
Bram Moolenaar7b0294c2004-10-11 10:16:09 +00007534 option that may have been set from a modeline, e.g.
7535 'foldexpr'.
7536
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00007537 *sandbox-option*
7538A few options contain an expression. When this expression is evaluated it may
Bram Moolenaar9b2200a2006-03-20 21:55:45 +00007539have to be done in the sandbox to avoid a security risk. But the sandbox is
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00007540restrictive, thus this only happens when the option was set from an insecure
7541location. Insecure in this context are:
Bram Moolenaar551dbcc2006-04-25 22:13:59 +00007542- sourcing a .vimrc or .exrc in the current directory
Bram Moolenaarb71eaae2006-01-20 23:10:18 +00007543- while executing in the sandbox
7544- value coming from a modeline
7545
7546Note that when in the sandbox and saving an option value and restoring it, the
7547option will still be marked as it was set in the sandbox.
7548
7549==============================================================================
755012. Textlock *textlock*
7551
7552In a few situations it is not allowed to change the text in the buffer, jump
7553to another window and some other things that might confuse or break what Vim
7554is currently doing. This mostly applies to things that happen when Vim is
7555actually doing something else. For example, evaluating the 'balloonexpr' may
7556happen any moment the mouse cursor is resting at some position.
7557
7558This is not allowed when the textlock is active:
7559 - changing the buffer text
7560 - jumping to another buffer or window
7561 - editing another file
7562 - closing a window or quitting Vim
7563 - etc.
7564
Bram Moolenaar071d4272004-06-13 20:20:40 +00007565
7566 vim:tw=78:ts=8:ft=help:norl: